12358
121
Zoom out
Zoom in
Previous page
1/124
Next page
INSTRUCTION MANUAL
HF/50 MHz
ALL MODE TRANSCEIVER
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is sub-
ject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause
harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
i
IMPORTANT
READ THIS INSTRUCTION MANUAL
CAREFULLY before attempting to operate the
transceiver.
SAVE THIS INSTRUCTION MANUAL. This
manual contains important safety and operating in-
structions for the IC-756PROIII.
EXPLICIT DEFINITIONS
WORD DEFINITION
RR
WARNING
Personal injury, fire hazard or electric
shock may occur.
CAUTION Equipment damage may occur.
NOTE
If disregarded, inconvenience only. No
risk or personal injury, fire or electric
shock.
Icom, Icom Inc. and the are registered trademarks of
Icom Incorporated (Japan) in the United States, the United
Kingdom, Germany, France, Spain, Russia and/or other
countries.
We understand that you have a choice of many differ-
ent radios in the market place. We would like to take a
couple of moments of your time to thank you for mak-
ing your IC-756PROIII your radio of choice, and hope
you agree with Icom’s philosophy of “technology first.”
Many hours of research and development went into
the design of your IC-756PROIII.
D
FEATURES
+30 dBm class IP3 (at 14 MHz band) and
further improved 3rd order IMD character-
istics
Real time spectrum scope with mini-scope
function
Boudot RTTY demodulator and RTTY
transmit message memory
Selectable SSB transmission passband
width (Each for Higher and lower pass fre-
quency)
Digital IF filter allows you to select 51 types
of filter shapes while receiving a station
The transceiver comes with the following acces-
sories.
Qty.
q DC power cable (OPC-025D) .......................... 1
w Hand microphone (HM-36) .............................. 1
e Spare fuses (FGB 30 A) .................................. 2
r Spare fuse (FGB 5 A) ...................................... 1
t CW keyer plug (AP-330) .................................. 1
qwe
r
t
Spurious may be received near the following frequencies.
These are made in the internal circuit and does not indicate a
transceiver malfunction:
6.144 MHz, 8.000 MHz,
12.288 MHz, 12.890 MHz (when spectrum scope is ON),
18.433 MHz, 24.573 MHz, 52 MHz
FOREWORD SUPPLIED ACCESSORIES
ii
R WARNING RF EXPOSURE! This device
emits Radio Frequency (RF) energy. Extreme caution
should be observed when operating this device. If you
have any questions regarding RF exposure and safety
standards please refer to the Federal Communications
Commission Office of Engineering and Technology’s
report on Evaluating Compliance with FCC Guidelines
for Human Radio Frequency Electromagnetic Fields
(OET Bulletin 65).
R WARNING HIGH VOLTAGE! NEVER at-
tach an antenna or internal antenna connector during
transmission. This may result in an electrical shock or
burn.
RWARNING! NEVER operate the transceiver
with a headset or other audio accessories at high vol-
ume levels. Hearing experts advise against continuous
high volume operation. If you experience a ringing in
your ears, reduce the volume or discontinue use.
RCAUTION! NEVER change the internal settings
of the transceiver. This result in reduced transceiver
performance and/or damage to the transceiver.
In particular, incorrect settings for transmitter circuits,
such as output power, idling current, etc., might dam-
age the expensive final devices.
The transceiver warranty does not cover any problems
caused by unauthorized internal adjustment.
R NEVER apply AC to the [DC13.8V] jack on the
transceiver rear panel. This could cause a fire or ruin
the transceiver.
RNEVER apply more than 16 V DC, such as a 24 V
battery, to the [DC13.8V] jack on the transceiver rear
panel. This could cause a fire or ruin the transceiver.
RNEVER let metal, wire or other objects touch any
internal part or connectors on the rear panel of the
transceiver. This may result in an electric shock.
R NEVER expose the transceiver to rain, snow or
any liquids.
RNEVER installing the transceiver in a place with-
out adequate ventilation. Heat dissipation may be af-
fected, and the transceiver may be damaged.
RNEVER operate or touch the transceiver with wet
hands. This may result in an electric shock or damage
to the transceiver.
AVOID using or placing the transceiver in areas with
temperatures below –10°C (+14°F) or above +50°C
(+122°F). Be aware that temperatures on a vehicle’s
dashboard can exceed 80°C (+176°F), resulting in per-
manent damage to the transceiver if left there for ex-
tended periods.
AVOID placing the transceiver in excessively dusty en-
vironments or in direct sunlight.
AVOID placing the transceiver against walls or putting
anything on top of the transceiver. This will obstruct
heat dissipation.
Place unit in a secure place to avoid inadvertent use
by children.
During mobile operation, DO NOT operate the trans-
ceiver without running the vehicle’s engine. When
transceiver power is ON and your vehicle’s engine is
OFF, the vehicle’s battery will soon become ex-
hausted.
Make sure the transceiver power is OFF before start-
ing the vehicle. This will avoid possible damage to the
transceiver by ignition voltage spikes.
During maritime mobile operation, keep the transceiver
and microphone as far away as possible from the mag-
netic navigation compass to prevent erroneous indica-
tions.
BE CAREFUL! The heatsink will become hot when op-
erating the transceiver continuously for long periods.
BE CAREFUL! If a linear amplifier is connected, set
the transceivers RF output power to less than the lin-
ear amplifiers maximum input level, otherwise, the lin-
ear amplifier will be damaged.
The LCD display may have cosmetic imperfections
that appear as small or dark spots. This is not a mal-
function or defect, but a normal characteristic of LCD
displays.
Use Icom microphones only (supplied or optional).
Other manufacturers microphones have different pin
assignments, and connection to the IC-756PROIII may
damage the transceiver.
For U.S.A. only
CAUTION: Changes or modifications to this device,
not expressly approved by Icom Inc., could void your
authority to operate this device under FCC regulations.
PRECAUTIONS
iii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
IMPORTANT .................................................................. i
FOREWORD ................................................................. i
EXPLICIT DEFINITIONS ............................................... i
SUPPLIED ACCESSORIES .......................................... i
PRECAUTIONS ............................................................ ii
TABLE OF CONTENTS .............................................. iii
1PANEL DESCRIPTION ..................................... 112
Front panel ....................................................... 1
LCD display ..................................................... 9
Screen menu arrangement ............................ 10
Rear panel ...................................................... 11
Microphone (HM-36) ...................................... 12
2 INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS .......... 1320
Unpacking ...................................................... 13
Selecting a location ........................................ 13
Grounding ...................................................... 13
Antenna connection ....................................... 13
Required connections .................................... 14
Advanced connections ................................... 15
Power supply connections ............................. 16
Linear amplifier connections .......................... 17
External antenna tuner
connections .................................................... 18
Transverter jack information .......................... 18
Microphone connector information ................ 18
FSK and AFSK (SSTV)
connections .................................................... 19
Accessory connector information ................... 20
3 BASIC OPERATION ....................................... 2132
When first applying power
(CPU resetting) .............................................. 21
Initial settings ................................................. 21
VFO description ............................................. 22
Selecting VFO/memory mode ........................ 23
Main/Sub band selection ............................... 23
Selecting an operating band .......................... 24
DUsing the band stacking registers ............... 24
Frequency setting .......................................... 25
DTuning with the tuning dial........................... 25
DDirect frequency entry with the keypad ....... 25
DQuick tuning step......................................... 26
DSelecting “kHz” step .................................... 26
DSelecting 1 Hz step...................................... 27
D
1
4 tuning function
(SSB data/CW/RTTY only) .......................... 27
DAuto tuning step function............................. 28
DBand edge warning beep............................. 28
Operating mode selection .............................. 29
Volume setting ............................................... 29
Squelch and receive (RF) sensitivity ............. 30
Meter function ................................................ 31
SWR reading ................................................. 31
Basic transmit operation ................................ 32
DTransmitting................................................. 32
DMicrophone gain adjustment ....................... 32
4 RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT ............................ 3354
Operating SSB ............................................... 33
DConvenient functions for receive ................. 33
DConvenient functions for transmit................ 34
DAbout 5 MHz band operation
(USA version only)....................................... 34
Operating CW ................................................ 35
DConvenient functions for receive ................. 35
DConvenient functions for transmit................ 36
DAbout CW reverse mode ............................. 36
DCW side tone function ................................. 36
DAbout CW pitch control................................ 37
Electronic CW keyer ...................................... 38
DMemory keyer send screen ......................... 39
DEditing a memory keyer............................... 40
DContest number set mode ........................... 41
DKeyer set mode ........................................... 42
Operating RTTY (FSK) .................................. 44
DConvenient functions for receive ................. 44
DAbout RTTY reverse mode.......................... 45
DRTTY filter/Twin peak filter........................... 45
DFunctions for the RTTY decoder indication . 46
DSetting the decoder threshold level ............. 46
DRTTY memory transmission ........................ 47
DRTTY tuning meter ...................................... 47
DEditing RTTY memory ................................. 48
DRTTY decoder set mode.............................. 49
Operating AM ................................................. 50
DConvenient functions for receive ................. 50
DConvenient functions for transmit................ 50
Operating FM ................................................. 51
DConvenient functions for receive ................. 51
DConvenient functions for transmit................ 51
Repeater operation ........................................ 52
DSetting the repeater tone............................. 52
Tone squelch operation .................................. 53
Data mode (SSTV/PSK31) operation ............ 54
5 FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE ............................ 5565
Spectrum scope screen ................................. 55
DMini scope screen........................................ 55
DScope set mode........................................... 56
Preamplifier .................................................... 57
Attenuator ...................................................... 57
RIT function .................................................... 58
AGC function .................................................. 59
Twin PBT operation ........................................ 60
IF filter selection ............................................. 61
DSP filter shape.............................................. 62
Dualwatch operation ...................................... 63
Noise blanker ................................................. 64
Notch function ................................................ 64
Noise reduction .............................................. 65
Dial lock function ............................................ 65
iv
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
6 FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT ......................... 6672
VOX function .................................................. 66
DUsing the VOX function ............................... 66
DAdjusting the VOX function.......................... 66
Break-in function ............................................ 67
DSemi break-in operation .............................. 67
DFull break-in operation................................. 67
Transmit filter width setting (SSB only) .......... 68
Speech compressor ....................................... 68
TX function .................................................. 69
Monitor function ............................................. 70
Split frequency operation ............................... 71
Quick split function ......................................... 72
7 VOICE RECORDER FUNCTIONS ................. 7376
Digital voice recorder ..................................... 73
8 MEMORY OPERATION .................................. 7782
Memory channels .......................................... 77
Memory channel selection ............................. 77
Memory channel screen ................................ 78
Memory channel programming ...................... 79
Frequency transferring ................................... 80
Memory names .............................................. 81
Memory clearing ............................................ 81
Memo pads .................................................... 82
9 SCANS ........................................................... 8387
Scan types ..................................................... 83
Preparation .................................................... 83
Programmed scan operation ......................... 84
F scan operation ......................................... 84
Fine programmed scan/
fine F scan ................................................... 85
Memory scan operation ................................. 85
Select memory scan operation ...................... 86
Setting select memory channels .................... 86
Scan set mode ............................................... 87
Tone scan ....................................................... 87
10 ANTENNA TUNER OPERATION ................... 8890
Automatic antenna selection .......................... 88
Antenna tuner operation ................................ 89
Optional external tuner operation .................. 90
11 CLOCK AND TIMERS .................................... 9193
Time set mode ............................................... 91
DSetting the current time ............................... 92
DClock2 function activity................................ 92
DClock2 offset setting .................................... 92
DTimer function activity.................................. 92
DSetting power-on time.................................. 93
DSetting power-off period............................... 93
DTimer operation............................................ 93
12 SET MODE ................................................... 94104
Set mode description ..................................... 94
Level set mode .............................................. 95
Display set mode ........................................... 97
DSP filter set mode......................................... 99
Miscellaneous (others) set mode ................... 99
13 OPTION INSTALLATION .................................... 105
Opening the transceivers case ................... 105
UT-102
VOICE SYNTHESIZER UNIT
.................. 105
14 INTERNAL VIEWS .............................................. 106
15 MAINTENANCE ......................................... 107109
Troubleshooting ........................................... 107
Fuse replacement ........................................ 108
Clock backup battery
replacement ................................................. 108
Tuning dial brake adjustment ....................... 109
Frequency calibration
(approximate)................................................ 109
16 CONTROL COMMAND ............................... 110–114
Remote jack (CI-V) information .................... 110
17 SPECIFICATIONS ............................................... 115
18 OPTIONS ............................................................. 116
19 ABOUT CE........................................................... 117
1
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
Front panel
q POWER SWITCH [POWER•TIMER]
While transceiver’s power is OFF:
Push to turn power ON.
•Turn the optional DC power supply ON in advance.
A/D converter calibration of the DSP unit starts and it
takes approx. 10 sec.
While transceiver’s power is ON:
Push momentarily to toggle the timer function
ON and OFF. (p. 93)
The [TIMER] indicator in this switch lights while
the timer function is ON.
Push for 1 sec. to turn power OFF.
w TRANSMIT SWITCH [TRANSMIT]
Selects transmitting or receiving.
The [TX] indicator lights red while transmitting and the
[RX] indicator lights green when the squelch is open.
e HEADPHONE JACK [PHONES]
Accepts headphones.
•Output power: 5 mW with an 8 load.
When headphones are connected, the internal speaker
or connected external speaker does not function.
r ELECTRONIC KEYER JACK [ELEC-KEY]
Accepts a paddle to activate the internal electronic
keyer for CW operation. (p. 38)
Selection between the internal electronic keyer, bug-key
and straight key operation can be made in keyer set
mode. (p. 43)
•A straight key jack is separately available on the rear
panel. See [KEY] on p. 11.
Keyer polarity (dot and dash) can be reversed in keyer
set mode. (p. 43)
4-channel memory keyer is available for your conve-
nience. (p. 40)
t MICROPHONE CONNECTOR [MIC]
Accepts the supplied or optional microphone.
See p. 116 for appropriate microphones.
See p. 18 for microphone connector information.
y AF CONTROL [AF] (inner control)
Varies the audio output level from the speaker.
u MIC GAIN CONTROL [MIC GAIN]
Adjusts microphone input gain.
The transmit audio tone in SSB mode can be adjusted in
set mode. (p. 95)
How to set the microphone gain.
Set the [MIC] control so that the ALC meter sometimes
swings during normal voice level transmission in SSB mode.
MIC GAIN
Recommended level for
an Icom microphone
Increases
Decreases
MIC GAIN
AF RF/SQL
No audio output
Max. audio output
Decreases Increases
(dot)
(com)
(dash)
TIMER
POWER
TRANSMIT
PHONES
ELEC-KEY
MIC
TUNER MONITOR NB NR
AF BAL NRRF/SQL
MIC GAIN RF POWER COMP BK-IN DELAY KEY SPEED
F-1 F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
HF/50MHz TRANSCEIVER
SSB
CW/RTTY
AM/FM FILTER EXIT/SET
q
w
e
r
t
!0!1!2
yiou
2
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
1
i RF GAIN CONTROL/SQUELCH CONTROL
[RF/SQL] (outer control)
Adjusts the RF gain and squelch threshold level.
The squelch removes noise output from the
speaker (closed condition) when no signal is re-
ceived.
The squelch is particularly effective for FM. It is also
available for other modes.
12 to 1 o’clock position is recommended for any setting
of the [RF/SQL] control.
The control can be set as ‘Auto’ (RF gain control in SSB,
CW and RTTY; squelch control in AM and FM) or
squelch control (RF gain is fixed at maximum) in set
mode as follows. (p. 99)
When setting as RF gain/squelch control
When functioning as RF gain control
(Squelch is fixed open; SSB, CW, RTTY only)
When functioning as squelch control
(RF gain is fixed at maximum.)
While rotating the RF gain control, noise may be
heard. This comes from the DSP unit and does not
indicate an equipment malfunction.
o RF POWER CONTROL [RF POWER]
Continuously varies the RF output power from min-
imum
(5 W*) to maximum (100 W*).
*AM mode: 5 W to 40 W
!0 S/RF METER (p. 31)
Shows the signal strength while receiving. Shows
the relative output power, SWR, ALC or compres-
sion levels while transmitting.
!1 MONITOR SWITCH [MONITOR] (p. 70)
Monitors your transmitted IF signal.
The CW side tone functions regardless of the [MONI-
TOR] switch setting in CW mode.
The [MONITOR] indicator in this switch lights green
when the function is activated.
!2 ANTENNA TUNER SWITCH [TUNER] (p. 89)
Turns the internal antenna tuner ON and OFF
(bypass)
when pushed momentarily.
Tunes the antenna manually when pushed for 1
sec.
The [TUNER] indicator in this switch lights red when
the function is activated or blinks during manual tun-
ing.
When the tuner cannot tune the antenna, the tuning
circuit is bypassed automatically after 20 sec.
Increases
max. 100 W
(40 W for AM)
Decreases
min. 5 W
RF POWER
Squelch is
open.
S-meter
squelch
S-meter squelch
threshold
Noise squelch
threshold
(FM mode)
Shallow Deep
Noise squelch (FM mode)
Minimum RF gain
Adjustable
range
Maximum
RF gain
Recommended level
RF gain
adjustable
range
Maximum
RF gain
S-meter
squelch
Noise squelch (FM mode)
Squelch is
open.
MODE
SSB, CW
RTTY
AM, FM
AUTO
RF GAIN
SQL
SQL
SET MODE SETTING
SQL
SQL
RF GAIN + SQL
RF GAIN + SQL
RF GAIN + SQL
3
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
Front panel (continued)
!3 COMPRESSION LEVEL CONTROL [COMP]
(p. 68)
Adjusts the speech compression level in SSB.
!4 SEMI BREAK-IN DELAY CONTROL
[BK-IN DELAY]
Adjusts the transmit-to-receive switching delay time
for CW semi break-in operation.
!5 ELECTRONIC CW KEYER SPEED CONTROL
[KEY SPEED] (p. 35)
Adjusts the internal electronic CW keyers speed.
•6 wpm (min.) to 60 wpm (max.) can be set.
!6 MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCHES
Push to select the functions indicated in the LCD
display to the right of these switches.
Functions vary depending on the operating condition.
Selects the antenna connector between
ANT1 and ANT2 when pushed. (p. 88)
Turns the [RX ANT] (receive antenna) ON
and OFF when pushed for 1 sec.
When the receive antenna is activated, the
antenna which is connected to the [ANT1] or
[ANT2] is used for transmission only.
When a transverter is in use, this [ANT]
does not function and ‘XVERT’ appears.
Selects RF power
(Po), SWR, ALC or
COMP metering during transmit. (p. 31)
Switches the multi-function digital meter
ON and OFF when pushed for 1 sec.
Selects one of 2 receive RF preamps or
bypasses them. (p. 57)
•“P. AMP1” activates 10 dB preamp.
•“P. AMP2” activates 16 dB high-gain preamp.
What is the preamp?
The preamp amplifies received signals in the front end cir-
cuit to improve the S/N ratio and increase the sensitivity. Se-
lect “P. AMP1” or “P. AMP2” when receiving weak signals.
Selects 6 dB, 12 dB or 18 dB attenuator,
or bypasses them. (p. 57)
What is the attenuator?
The attenuator prevents a desired signal from distorting
when very strong signals are near the desired frequency, or
when very strong electric fields, such as from a broadcast-
ing station, are near your location.
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
P.AMP
P.AMP
OFF
OFF
METER
METER
Po
Po
ANT
ANT
1
Slow
Fast
KEY SPEED
BK-IN DELAY
Short delay for
high speed keying
(2 dot)
Long delay for
slow speed keying
(13 dot)
COMP
Compression
level decreases
Compression
level increases
TIMER
POWER
TRANSMIT
PHONES
ELEC-KEY
MIC
TUNER MONITOR NB NR
AF BAL NRRF/SQL
MIC GAIN RF POWER COMP BK-IN DELAY KEY SPEED
F-1 F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
HF/50MHz TRANSCEIVER
SSB
CW/RTTY
AM/FM FILTER EXIT/SET
!5!4!3
!6!7!8@0 !9
4
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
1
Activates or selects fast, middle or slow
AGC time constant when pushed. (p. 59)
•“FAST” is only available for FM mode.
Enters the AGC set mode when pushed
for 1 sec. (p. 59)
AGC time constant can be set between 0.1 to
8.0 sec.
(depends on mode), or turned OFF. While
“OFF” is selected, the S-meter does not function.
What is the AGC?
The AGC function controls receiver gain to produce a con-
stant audio output level, even when the received signal
strength is varied by fading, etc. Select “FAST” for tuning and
select “MID” or “SLOW” depending on the receiving condi-
tion.
Turns the VOX function ON and OFF
when pushed in a phone mode (SSB, AM
or FM mode). (p. 66)
Enters the VOX set mode when pushed
for 1 sec. in a phone mode. (p. 66)
What is the VOX function?
The VOX function (voice operated transmission) starts trans-
mission without pushing the transmit switch or PTT switch
when you speak into the microphone; then, automatically re-
turns to receive when you stop speaking.
Selects semi break-in, full break-in oper-
ation, or turns the break-in operation
OFF when pushed in CW mode. (p. 67)
What is the break-in function?
The break-in function switches transmit and receive with CW
keying. Full break-in function (QSK) can monitor the receive
signal during keying.
Turns the RTTY filter ON and OFF in
RTTY mode. (p. 45)
When the RTTY filter is turned ON, [TWIN
PBT] functions as the IF shift control.
Enters the RTTY filter set mode when
pushed for 1 sec. in RTTY mode. (p. 45)
What is the IF shift?
The IF shift function electronically changes the center of the
IF (Intermediate Frequency) passband frequency to reject in-
terference. Only the inner control of [TWIN PBT] can be
used for the IF shift control.
Turns the speech compressor ON and
OFF in SSB mode. (p. 68)
Switches the narrow, middle or wide
transmit filter when pushed for 1 sec.
What is the speech compressor?
The speech compressor compresses the transmitter audio
input to increase the average audio output level. Therefore,
talk power is increased. This function is effective for long dis-
tance communication or when propagation conditions are
poor.
Turns the
1
4 function ON and OFF in
SSB data, CW and RTTY modes. (p. 27)
1
4 function sets dial rotation to
1
4 of normal
for fine tuning.
Switches the tone encoder, tone squelch
function and no tone operation when
pushed in FM mode. (pgs. 52, 53)
Enters the tone set mode when pushed
for 1 sec. in FM mode. (pgs. 52, 53)
!7 NOISE REDUCTION LEVEL CONTROL [NR]
(outer control; p. 65)
Adjusts the noise reduction level when the noise re-
duction is in use. Set for maximum readability.
•To activate this control, turn the noise reduction ON in
advance (!8).
!8 NOISE REDUCTION SWITCH [NR] (p. 65)
Push to switch the noise reduction ON and OFF.
The [NR] indicator in this switch lights green when the
function is activated.
!9 NOISE BLANKER SWITCH [NB] (p. 64)
Switches the noise blanker ON and OFF when
pushed. The noise blanker reduces pulse-type
noise such as that generated by automobile igni-
tion systems. This function cannot be used for
FM mode, or non-pulse-type noise.
The [NB] indicator in this switch lights green when the
function is activated.
Enters the noise blanker level set mode when
pushed for 1 sec.
@0 BALANCE CONTROL [BAL] (inner control; p. 63)
Adjusts the audio output balance between main and
sub readout frequencies while in dualwatch.
BAL NR
Increases main
readout gain
Increases sub
readout gain
Noise blanker OFF Noise blanker ON
NB NB
Noise reduction OFF Noise reduction ON
NR NR
BAL NR
Decreases
OFF
Increases
TONE
TONE
OFF
OFF
1/4
1/4
OFF
OFF
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
RTTY
RTTY
FIL
FIL
OFF
OFF
BK-IN
BK-IN
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
5
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
Front panel (continued)
@1 LCD FUNCTION SWITCHES [F-1]–[F-5]
Push to select the function indicated in the LCD dis-
play above these switches.
Functions vary depending on the operating condition.
@2 MODE SWITCHES
Selects the desired mode. (p. 29)
Announces the selected mode when an optional UT-102
is installed. (pgs. 102, 105)
Selects USB and LSB mode alternately.
Selects SSB data mode (USB-D, LSB-D)
when pushed for 1 sec. in SSB mode.
Selects CW and RTTY mode alternately.
Switches CW and CW-R
(CW reverse)
mode when pushed for 1 sec. in CW
mode.
Switches RTTY and RTTY-R (RTTY re-
verse)
mode when pushed for 1 sec. in
RTTY mode.
Selects AM and FM mode alternately.
Selects AM/FM data mode
(AM-D, FM-D)
when pushed for 1 sec. in AM or FM
mode.
@3 FILTER SWITCH [FILTER] (p. 61)
Push to select one of 3 IF filter settings.
Push for 1 sec. to enter the filter set mode.
@4 EXIT/SET SWITCH [EXIT/SET]
Push to exit from a set mode, etc.
Push for 1 sec. to enter the set mode screen.
(p. 94)
@5 REC/PLAY SWITCH [REC/PLAY] (p. 73)
Push momentarily to playback the recorded con-
tents in the channel R4 of the voice memory.
Push for 1 sec. to record the receiving signal con-
tents into the channel R4
(max. 15 sec.) of the
voice memory.
@6 TUNING DIAL (p. 25)
Changes the displayed frequency, selects set mode
settings, etc.
@7 LOCK/SPEECH SWITCH [LOCK/SPEECH]
Push momentarily to toggle the dial lock function
ON and OFF. (p. 65)
Push for 1 sec. to announce the S-meter indica-
tion and the selected readout frequency when an
optional UT-102 is installed. (p. 105)
@8 RIT/
TX CONTROL [RIT/
TX] (pgs. 58, 69)
Shifts the receive and/or transmit frequency without
changing the transmit and/or receive frequency
while the RIT and/or TX functions are ON.
Rotate the control clockwise to increase the frequency,
or rotate the control counterclockwise to decrease the
frequency.
The shift frequency range is ±9.999 kHz in 1 Hz steps
(or ±9.99 kHz in 10 Hz steps).
RIT/TX
Low shift High shift
AM/FM
CW/RTTY
SSB
NB NR
BAL NR
COMP BK-IN DELAY KEY SPEED
LOCKTX
RX
TWIN PBT
CW PITCH
F-1 F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
REC/PLAY
LOCK/SPEECH
RIT/ TX
TXRIT CLEAR
SPLIT
MP-W MP-R
DUAL
WATCH
VFO/
MEMO
MAIN/
SUB
M.SCOPE
CHANGE
1.8 3.5 7
10 14 18
21 24 28
GENE
50
123
456
789
0
F-INP
ENT
Y
Z
MW
M-CL
TS
XFC
EIVER
i7500
PBT CLR NOTCH
NOTCH
SSB
CW/RTTY
AM/FM FILTER EXIT/SET
@2 @4@3 @5 @6
#6
#0
#2
#3
@9
#4
#5
#1
@8
@7
@1
6
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
1
@9
TX SWITCH [
TX] (p. 69)
Turns the TX function ON and OFF when
pushed.
Use the [RIT/
TX] control to vary the TX frequency.
Adds the TX shift frequency to the operating
frequency when pushed for 1 sec.
What is the
TX function?
The TX shifts the transmit frequency without shifting the re-
ceive frequency. This is useful for simple split frequency op-
eration in CW, etc.
#0 CLEAR SWITCH [CLEAR] (pgs. 58, 69)
Clears the RIT/TX shift frequency when pushed
for 1 sec. (default).
The response time (for 1 sec. or momentarily) can be
selected on the quick RIT/TX clear setting (p. 103).
#1 RIT SWITCH [RIT] (p. 58)
Turns the RIT function ON and OFF when
pushed.
Use the [RIT/
TX] control to vary the RIT frequency.
Adds the RIT shift frequency to the operating fre-
quency when pushed for 1 sec.
What is the RIT function?
The RIT (Receiver Incremental Tuning) shifts the receive fre-
quency without shifting the transmit frequency.
This is useful for fine tuning stations calling you on an off-fre-
quency or when you prefer to listen to slightly different-
sounding voice characteristics, etc.
#2 MANUAL NOTCH FILTER CONTROL [NOTCH]
(inner control; p. 64)
Varies the peak frequency of the manual notch fil-
ter to pick out a receive signal from interference
while the manual notch function is ON.
Notch filter center frequency:
SSB : 0 Hz to 5100 Hz
CW : CW pitch freq.–900 Hz to CW pitch freq.
+4200 Hz
AM : –5100 Hz to 5100 Hz
#3 CW PITCH CONTROL [CW PITCH]
(outer control; p. 37)
Shifts the received CW audio pitch and monitored
CW audio pitch without changing the operating fre-
quency.
#4 NOTCH SWITCH [NOTCH] (p. 64)
Switches the notch function between auto, man-
ual and OFF in SSB and AM modes.
Turns the manual notch function ON and OFF
when pushed in CW mode.
Turns the auto notch function ON and OFF when
pushed in FM mode.
•“AN” appears on the display when auto notch is in
use.
•“MN” appears on the display when manual notch is in
use.
The [NOTCH] indicator in this switch lights green
when the function is activated.
What is the notch function?
The notch function eliminates unwanted CW or AM carrier
tones while preserving the desired signal’s audio response.
The filtering frequency is adjusted to effectively eliminate un-
wanted tones via the DSP circuit.
#5 PBT CLEAR SWITCH [PBT CLR] (p. 60)
Clears the PBT settings when pushed for 1 sec.
The [PBT CLR] indicator in this switch lights green when
PBT is in use.
#6 PASSBAND TUNING CONTROLS [TWIN PBT]
Adjust the receivers “passband width” of the DSP
filter. (p. 60)
Passband width and shift frequency are displayed in the
LCD.
Push [PBT CLR] for 1 sec. to clear the settings when
not in use.
•Variable range is set to half of the IF filter passband
width. 25 Hz steps and 50 Hz steps are available.
These controls function as an IF shift control while in AM
mode and when the RTTY filter is turned ON. Only the
inner control may function in this case.
What is the PBT control?
General PBT function electronically narrows the IF passband
width to reject interference. This transceiver uses the DSP
circuit for the PBT function.
Low cut High cutCenter
TWIN PBT TWIN PBT TWIN PBT
–+
PBT1
PBT2
TWIN PBT
NOTCHNOTCH
Notch OFF Notch ON
Approx. 300 Hz
Approx. 900 Hz
Lower frequency Higher frequency
NOTCH CW PITCH
NOTCH CW PITCH
Lower frequency Higher frequency
7
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
Front panel (continued)
#7 RECEIVE INDICATOR [RX]
Lights green while receiving a signal and when the
squelch is open.
#8 TRANSMIT INDICATOR [TX]
Lights red while transmitting.
#9 LOCK INDICATOR [LOCK] (p. 65)
Lights red when the dial lock function is activated.
$0 TRANSMIT FREQUENCY CHECK SWITCH
[XFC]
Monitors the transmit frequency when pushed and
held during the split frequency operation.
While pushing this switch, the transmit frequency can be
changed with the tuning dial, keypad, memo pad or the
[
YY
]/[
ZZ
] switches.
When the split lock function is turned ON, pushing [XFC]
cancels the dial lock function. (p. 100)
$1 QUICK TUNING SWITCH [TS] (p. 26)
Turns the quick tuning step ON and OFF.
While the quick tuning indicator, “Z,” is displayed
above the frequency indication, the frequency can be
changed in programmed kHz steps.
0.1, 1, 5, 9, 10, 12.5, 20 and 25 kHz quick tuning
steps are available for each operating mode indepen-
dently.
When the quick tuning step is OFF, push for 1
sec. to turn the 1 Hz tuning step ON and OFF.
•1 Hz indications appear in both readouts and the fre-
quency can be changed in 1 Hz steps.
When the quick tuning step is ON, push for 1 sec.
to enter the quick tuning step set mode.
$2 MEMORY CLEAR SWITCH [M-CL] (p. 81)
Clears the selected readout memory channel con-
tents when pushed for 1 sec. in memory mode.
The channel becomes a blank channel.
This switch does not function in VFO mode.
$3 MEMORY WRITE SWITCH [MW] (p. 79)
Stores the selected readout frequency and operat-
ing mode into the displayed memory channel when
pushed for 1 sec.
This function is available both in VFO and memory
modes.
$4 MEMORY UP/DOWN SWITCHES [
YY
]/[
ZZ
] (p. 77)
Push to select the memory channel number for
the selected readout.
Memory channels can be selected both in VFO and
memory modes.
Select the desired memory channel directly after
pushing [(F-INP)ENT] and a memory channel
number.
$5 MEMO PAD-READ SWITCH [MP-R] (p. 82)
Each pushing calls up a frequency and operating
mode in a memo pad. The 5 (or 10) most recently
programmed frequencies and operating modes can
be recalled, starting from the most recent.
The memo pad capacity can be expanded from 5 to 10
in set mode for your convenience. (p. 102)
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
TXTX
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
21.076.5021.076.50
VFOVFO
USBUSB
1
METER
Po
ANT
1
qw:pp
12:0012:00
Quick tuning indicator
NB NR
BAL NR
COMP BK-IN DELAY KEY SPEED
LOCKTX
RX
TWIN PBT
CW PITCH
F-1 F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
REC/PLAY
LOCK/SPEECH
RIT/ TX
TXRIT CLEAR
SPLIT
MP-W MP-R
DUAL
WATCH
VFO/
MEMO
MAIN/
SUB
M.SCOPE
CHANGE
1.8
1
3.5
2
7
3
10
4
14
5
18
6
21
7
24
8
28
9
GENE
50
0
F-INP
ENT
Y
Z
MW
M-CL
TS
XFC
CEIVER
PBT CLR NOTCH
NOTCH
SSB
CW/RTTY
AM/FM FILTER EXIT/SET
%2 %1 $7
$5
$6$9%0 $8
#7 #8 #9
$4
%3
$3
$2
$1
$0
8
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
$6 KEYPAD
Pushing a key selects the operating band.
[(GENE)•] selects the general coverage band.
Pushing the same key 2 or 3 times calls up other
stacked frequencies in the band. (p. 24)
Icom’s triple band stacking register memorizes 3 fre-
quencies in each band.
After pushing [(F-INP)ENT], enters a keyed fre-
quency or memory channel. Pushing [(F-
INP)ENT] or [
YY
]/[
ZZ
] is necessary at the end.
(pgs. 25, 77)
e.g. to enter 14.195 MHz, push [(F-INP)ENT] [1] [4]
[•] [1] [9] [5] [(F-INP)ENT].
$7 MEMO PAD-WRITE SWITCH [MP-W] (p. 82)
Programs the selected readout frequency and op-
erating mode into a memo pad.
The 5 most recent entries remain in memo pads.
The transmit frequency is programmed when pushed to-
gether with [XFC].
The memo pad capacity can be expanded from 5 to 10
in set mode for your convenience. (p. 102)
$8 SPLIT SWITCH [SPLIT] (p. 71)
Turns the split function ON and OFF when
pushed.
Turns the split function ON, equalizes the sub
readout frequency to the main readout and sets
the sub readout for frequency input when pushed
for 1 sec. in non-FM modes.
(Quick split function)
The offset frequency is shifted from the main readout
frequency in FM mode. (pgs. 52, 100)
The quick split function can be turned OFF using set
mode. (p. 100)
Turns the split function ON and shifts the sub
readout frequency after input an offset (±4 MHz
in 1 kHz steps).
$9 DUALWATCH SWITCH [DUALWATCH] (p. 63)
Turns the dualwatch function ON and OFF when
pushed.
Turns the dualwatch function ON and equalizes
the sub readout frequency to the main readout
when pushed for 1 sec. (Quick dualwatch function)
The quick dualwatch function can be turned OFF
using set mode. (p. 98)
%0 MAIN/SUB CHANGE SWITCH [CHANGE]
Switches the frequency and selected memory
channel between main and sub readouts when
pushed.
Switches between transmit frequency and receive fre-
quency when the split frequency function is ON.
(p. 71)
Equalizes the sub readout frequency to the main
readout frequency when pushed for 1 sec.
%1 VFO/MEMORY SWITCH [VFO/MEMO]
Switches the selected readout operating mode
between the VFO mode and memory mode when
pushed. (pgs. 23, 77)
Transfers the memory contents to VFO when
pushed for 1 sec. (p. 80)
%2 MAIN/SUB•M.SCOPE SWITCH
[MAIN/SUB•M.SCOPE]
Push momentarily to select access to the main or
sub readout. (p. 23)
The sub readout frequency is displayed in outline or
mesh font. The sub readout functions only during split
operation or dualwatch.
Push for 1 sec. to turn the mini spectrum scope
screen indication ON and OFF. (p. 55)
The mini spectrum scope screen can be indicated
with another screen, such as memory, set mode
screen, simultaneously.
%3 LCD FUNCTION DISPLAY (See p. 9 for details.)
Shows the operating frequency, function switch
menus, spectrum scope screen, memory channel
screen, set mode settings, etc.
1
9
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
LCD display
q TX INDICATOR
Indicates the frequency readout for transmission.
w VFO/MEMORY CHANNEL INDICATOR
(pgs. 23, 77)
Indicates the VFO mode or selected memory chan-
nel number.
e SELECT MEMORY CHANNEL INDICATOR (p. 86)
Indicates the displayed memory channel is set as a
select memory channel.
r MULTI-FUNCTION SWITCH GUIDE
Indicates the function of the multi-function switches.
t LCD FUNCTION SWITCH GUIDE
Indicates the function of the LCD function switches
([F-1][F-5]).
y MULTI-FUNCTION SCREEN (p. 10)
Shows the screens for the multi-function digital
meter, spectrum scope, voice recorder, memory
channel, scan, memory keyer, RTTY decoder, IF fil-
ter selection or set modes, etc.
u MEMORY CHANNEL READOUTS (p. 77)
Show the selected memory channel contents in
VFO mode.
Show the VFO contents in memory mode.
i FREQUENCY READOUTS (p. 25)
Show the operating frequency.
Outline characters are used for non-accessing readout.
o CLOCK READOUT (p. 92)
Shows the current time.
Dualtime indication is available.
!0 RTTY TUNING INDICATOR (p. 47)
Shows the tuning level in RTTY mode.
!1 QUICK TUNING INDICATOR (p. 26)
Appears when the quick tuning step function is in
use.
!2 PASSBAND WIDTH INDICATOR (pgs. 60, 61)
Graphically displays the passband width for twin
PBT operation and center frequency for IF shift op-
eration.
!3 IF FILTER INDICATOR (p. 61)
Shows the selected IF filter number.
!4 SHIFT FREQUENCY INDICATOR (p. 60)
Shows the shift frequency of the IF filter.
!5 MODE INDICATOR (p. 29)
Shows the selected mode.
!6 BAND WIDTH INDICATOR (p. 61)
Shows the passband width of the IF filter.
ANT
1
COMP
OFF
WIDE
HOLD
SUB
MARKER
ATT
10dB
Grid
10k
10dB
SPAN
ATT
MARKER
HOLD
SET
METER
Po
P.AMP
1
AGC
MID
ATT
OFF
VOX
OFF
+12.5k
+12.5k
-12.5k
-12.5k
SPECTRUM SCOPE
SPECTRUM SCOPE
BW
2.4k
SFT
0
USB
USB
qw:pp
VFO 21.085.00
TX
CW
FIL2
qr.qqy.pp
qr.qpp.pp
56ß
USB
21.085.00 CW
VFO
FIL2
23:00
23:00
t
i
i
!6 !4!5 !2!3 !1 !0 o
y
u
u
r
q
w
e
w
10
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
1
ATT
0FF
METER
Po
P.AMP
1
BK-IN
OFF
1/4
OFF
BW
2.4k
SFT
0
VFO
FIL2
CW
AGC
MID
1
TX
VFO
1
USB
CW
CW
FIL2
qr.qpp.pp
qr.qpp.pp
--. ---. --
--. ---. --
SCOPE
VOICE KEYER
MEMORY
SCAN
ANT
1
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
CQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOMCQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOM
TEST
QRZ?
CFM TUCFM TU
UR 5NNUR 5NN001 BK BK
M1M1
M2M2
M3M3
M4M4
M1
M2
M3
M4
-1
BK-IN
OFF
1/4
OFF
AGC
MID
T4 -
-
-
T1
-
-
-
T3
-
-
-
VOICE RECORDER
T2
-
-
-
TX MEMORY
T1
T2
T3
T4
T/R
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
GridGrid
2.5k2.5k
10dB10dB
+12. 5k+12. 5k
-12. 5k-12. 5k
SPECTRUM SCOPESPECTRUM SCOPE
SPANSPAN
ATTATT
MARKERMARKER
HOLDHOLD
SET
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
SCANSCAN
F SpanSpan : ± 10kHz 10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1: 0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scan edgesscan edges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
PROGPROG
F
FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
SCANSCAN
F
SpanSpan : ± 10kHz 10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1: 0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scan edgesscan edges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
MEMOMEMO
F
SELECTSELECT
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
THRESHOLD 9
RTTYRTTY
FILFIL
ONON
AGCAGC
MIDMID
RTTY DECODERTTY DECODE
MEMORY KEYERMEMORY KEYER
**** RTTY Decode Monitor ******** RTTY Decode Monitor ****
45bps BAUDOT Mark=2125,Shift=170 45bps BAUDOT Mark=2125,Shift=170
UnShift On Space support (SET-OTHERS) UnShift On Space support (SET-OTHERS)
New Line Code selectable (SET-OTHERS) New Line Code selectable (SET-OTHERS)
If RTTY-FIL is OFF, Please turn ON. If RTTY-FIL is OFF, Please turn ON.
1/41/4
OFFOFF
<MENU1><MENU1>
HLD/CLRHLD/CLR TX MEMTX MEM
ADJADJ
WIDEWIDE
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
MEMORYMEMORY
9999
--.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
PP 11 00 0.500.000.500.00 USBUSB FL2 SCAN EDGEFL2 SCAN EDGE
P2P2 29.999.9929.999.99 USBUSB FL2 SCAN EDGEFL2 SCAN EDGE
1 1 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
2 2 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
33 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
4 4 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
ROLLROLL
SETSET
SELECTSELECT
NAMENAME
WIDEWIDE
• Start up screen
• Voice recorder screen (p. 73)
• Memory keyer screen (CW mode: p. 40)
• Spectrum scope screen (p. 55)
• Memory channel screen (p. 78)
• Programmed scan screen (VFO mode: p. 84)
• RTTY decoder screen (RTTY mode: p. 46)
• Memory scan screen (Memory mode: p. 85)
F-1
F-1
F-4F-2
F-5
F-3
F-5
F-3
F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
qw:pp
12:00
Screen menu arrangement
The following screens can be selected from the start
up screen. Choose the desired screen using the fol-
lowing chart.
Pushing [EXIT/SET] several times returns to the start
up screen. See p. 94 for set mode arrangement.
11
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
Rear panel
q TRANSVERTER JACK [XVERT] (p. 18)
External transverter input/output jack. Activated by
voltage applied to [ACC(2)] pin 6.
w RECEIVE ANTENNA CONNECTOR [RX ANT]
(p. 15)
Connects a 50 general coverage antenna with an
RCA connector.
e TUNER CONTROL SOCKET [TUNER] (p. 15)
Accepts the control cable from an optional AH-4
HF/50 MHz AUTOMATIC ANTENNA TUNER or AH-3 HF
AUTOMATIC ANTENNA TUNER
.
r ACCESSORY SOCKET 1 [ACC(1)]
t ACCESSORY SOCKET 2 [ACC(2)]
Enable connection of external equipment such as a
linear amplifier, an automatic antenna selector/
tuner, TNC for data communications, etc.
See p. 20 for socket information.
y STRAIGHT KEY JACK [KEY] (p. 14)
Accepts a straight key or external electronic keyer
with
1
4 inch standard plug.
[ELEC-KEY] on the front panel can be used for a
straight key or external electronic keyer. Deactivate the
internal electronic keyer in keyer set mode. (p. 43)
If you use an external electronic keyer, make
sure the voltage retained by the keyer is less
than 0.4 V when the key is ON.
u CI-V REMOTE CONTROL JACK [REMOTE]
(p. 110)
Connects a PC via the optional CT-17
CI
-
V LEVEL
CONVERTER
for external control of the transceiver
functions.
Used for transceive operation with another Icom
CI-V transceiver or receiver.
i EXTERNAL SPEAKER JACK [EXT SP]
(pgs. 15, 116)
Accepts an 4–8 speaker.
o ALC INPUT JACK [ALC] (p. 17)
Connects to the ALC output jack of a non-Icom lin-
ear amplifier.
!0 SEND CONTROL JACK [SEND] (p. 17)
Goes to ground while transmitting to control exter-
nal equipment such as a linear amplifier.
Max. control level: 16 V DC/0.5 A
!1 DC POWER SOCKET [DC 13.8V] (p. 16)
Accepts 13.8 V DC through the supplied DC power
cable (OPC-025D).
Rear panel view
(+)
(_)
q w!0
!1
ertyuio
!4 !3 !2
12
1
PANEL DESCRIPTION
1
!2 ANTENNA CONNECTOR 1 [ANT1]
!3 ANTENNA CONNECTOR 2 [ANT2] (pgs. 13, 14)
Accept a 50 antenna with a PL-259 connector.
When using an optional AH-4 HF/50 MHz AUTO-
MATIC ANTENNA TUNER
or AH-3 HF AUTOMATIC AN-
TENNA TUNER
, connect it to the [ANT1] connector.
The internal antenna tuner activates for [ANT2] and
deactivates for [ANT1] when connecting the AH-4
or AH-3.
!4 GROUND TERMINAL [GND] (pgs. 13, 14)
Connect this terminal to a ground to prevent electri-
cal shocks, TVI, BCI and other problems.
Microphone
(HM-36)
q UP/DOWN SWITCHES [UP]/[DN]
Change the selected readout frequency or memory
channel.
Continuous pushing changes the frequency or memory
channel number continuously.
While pushing [XFC], the transmit readout frequency
can be controlled while in spilt frequency operation.
The [UP]/[DN] switch can simulate a key paddle. Preset
in the keyer set mode. (p. 43)
w PTT SWITCH
Push and hold to transmit; release to receive.
q
w
+
+
q
w
e
r
t
y
u
i
4700p
4700p
10µ
0.33µ
MICROPHONE
MIC
ELEMENT
2k
470
DOWN UP
PTT
RECEIVE
TRANSMIT
MICROPHONE CABLE MICROPHONE PLUG
• HM-36 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
Unpacking
After unpacking, immediately report any damage to the
delivering carrier or dealer. Keep the shipping cartons.
For a description and a diagram of accessory equip-
ment included with the IC-756PROIII, see ‘Supplied
accessories’ on p. i of this manual.
Selecting a location
Select a location for the transceiver that allows ade-
quate air circulation, free from extreme heat, cold, or
vibrations, and away from TV sets, TV antenna ele-
ments, radios and other electromagnetic sources.
The base of the transceiver has an adjustable stand
for desktop use. Set the stand to one of two angles de-
pending on your operating conditions.
Grounding
To prevent electrical shock, television interference
(TVI), broadcast interference (BCI) and other prob-
lems, ground the transceiver through the GROUND
terminal on the rear panel.
For best results, connect a heavy gauge wire or strap
to a long earth-sunk copper rod. Make the distance be-
tween the [GND] terminal and ground as short as pos-
sible.
RWARNING: NEVER connect the [GND]
terminal to a gas or electric pipe, since the connec-
tion could cause an explosion or electric shock.
Antenna connection
For radio communications, the antenna is of critical im-
portance, along with output power and sensitivity. Se-
lect antenna(s), such as a well-matched 50 antenna,
and feedline. 1.5:1 or better of Voltage Standing Wave
Ratio (VSWR) is recommended for your desired band.
Of course, the transmission line should be a coaxial
cable.
When using 1 antenna, use the [ANT1] connector.
CAUTION: Protect your transceiver from lightning
by using a lightning arrestor.
Antenna SWR
Each antenna is tuned for a specified frequency
range and SWR may be increased out-of-range.
When the SWR is higher than approx. 2.0:1, the
transceivers power drops to protect the final transis-
tor. In this case, an antenna tuner is useful to match
the transceiver and antenna. Low SWR allows full
power for transmitting even when using the antenna
tuner. The IC-756PROIII has an SWR meter to mon-
itor the antenna SWR continuously.
PL-259 CONNECTOR INSTALLATION EXAMPLE
30 mm
9
8 in 10 mm
3
8 in 1–2 mm
1
16 in
30 mm
10 mm (soft solder)
10 mm
1–2 mm
solder solder
Soft
solder
Coupling ring
Slide the coupling ring
down. Strip the cable
jacket and soft solder.
Slide the connector
body on and solder it.
Screw the coupling
ring onto the
connector body.
Strip the cable as
shown at left. Soft
solder the center con-
ductor.
q
w
e
r
13
2
14
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
2
Required connections
Front panel
Rear panel
SWR
S
COMP
ALC
Po
0
10
10
25 50
100
20
1
0
1.5
2
3
1
5
9
+20
+40
+60dB
dB
RIT/ TX
TX
F-1
SSB
F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
CW/RTTY
AM/FM FILTER EXIT/SET
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
ENT
NOTCH
PBT CLR
LOCKTX
RX
NOTCH
TWIN PBT
CW PITCH
REC/PLAY
LOCK/SPEECH
RIT CLEAR
SPLIT
MP-W MP-R
DUAL
WATCH
VFO/
MEMO
MAIN/
SUB
M.SCOPE
CHANGE
1.8 3.5 7
10 14 18
21 24 28
GENE
50
F-INP
MW
M-CL
TS
XFC
TIMER
POWER
TRANSMIT
PHONES
ELEC-KEY
MIC
TUNER MONITOR NB NR
AF BAL NRRF/SQL
MIC GAIN RF POWER COMP KEY SPEEDBK-IN DELAY
HF/50MHz TRANSCEIVER
CW KEY
A straight key can be used
when the internal electronic
keyer is turned OFF in keyer
set mode. (p. 43)
MICROPHONES (p. 116)
SM-20HM-36
GROUND (p. 13)
Use the heaviest gauge wire
or strap available and make
the connection as short as
possible.
Grounding prevents electrical
shocks, TVI and other
problems.
ANTENNA 1, 2 (p. 13)
[Example]: ANT1 for 1.8–18 MHz bands
ANT2 for 21–50 MHz bands
DC POWER SUPPLY (p.16)
STRAIGHT KEY
PS-125
15
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
Advanced connections
Front panel
Rear panel
SWR
S
COMP
ALC
Po
0
10
10
25 50
100
20
1
0
1.5
2
3
1
5
9
+20
+40
+60dB
dB
RIT/ TX
TX
F-1
SSB
F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
CW/RTTY
AM/FM FILTER EXIT/SET
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
ENT
NOTCH
PBT CLR
LOCKTX
RX
NOTCH
TWIN PBT
CW PITCH
REC/PLAY
LOCK/SPEECH
RIT CLEAR
SPLIT
MP-W MP-R
DUAL
WATCH
VFO/
MEMO
MAIN/
SUB
M.SCOPE
CHANGE
1.8 3.5 7
10 14 18
21 24 28
GENE
50
F-INP
MW
M-CL
TS
XFC
TIMER
POWER
TRANSMIT
PHONES
ELEC-KEY
MIC
TUNER MONITOR NB NR
AF BAL NRRF/SQL
MIC GAIN RF POWER COMP KEY SPEEDBK-IN DELAY
HF/50MHz TRANSCEIVER
HEADPHONES
MIC
The AFSK modulation signal
can be input from [MIC]. (p. 19)
ANTENNA 1, 2 (pgs. 17, 18)
Connects a linear amplifier,
antenna selector, etc.
EXTERNAL SPEAKER (p. 116)
ACC SOCKETS (pgs. 19, 20)
RX ANTENNA
TRANSVERTER
(p. 18)
Connects a transverter
for V/UHF band use.
SP-23
AH-4/AH-3
(p. 18)
AH-2b
[REMOTE] (p. 110)
Used for computer control and transceive operation.
[SEND], [ALC]
(p. 17)
Used for connecting a
non-Icom linear ampli-
fier.
When using the AH-4/AH-3,
it must be connected to the
[ANT1] connector.
16
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
2
Power supply connections
Use the optional PS-125 DC power supply with a 25 A
capacity when operating the transceiver with AC
power. Refer to the diagrams below.
CAUTION: Before connecting the DC power
cable, check the following important items. Make
sure:
The [POWER] switch is OFF.
Output voltage of the power source is 12–15 V
when you use a non-Icom power supply.
DC power cable polarity is correct.
Red : positive + terminal
Black : negative _ terminal
CONNECTING A DC POWER SUPPLY
CONNECTING A VEHICLE BATTERY
NOTE: Use terminals for
the cable connections.
R WARNING NEVER con-
nect to a battery without supplied
DC fuses, otherwise a fire hazard
may occur.
NEVER connect the transceiver
directly to a 24 V battery.
IMPORTANT! Detailed installation
notes for Icom mobile transceivers to
be fitted into vehicles are available.
Contact your Icom dealer or distribu-
tor.
CONNECTING PS-125 DC POWER SUPPLY
17
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
Linear amplifier connections
Use the [ANT1] connector when connecting a linear
amplifier.
CONNECTING THE IC-PW1/EURO
Turn OFF the transceivers antenna tuner while tuning the IC-PW1/EURO’s tuner.
To an
antenna
ACC-1
ANT
ANT2
ANT1
ACC(2)
INPUT1
INPUT2
REMOTE
EXCITER
1
1&2
GND
GND
IC-PW1/EURO
AC outlet
(Non-European versions: 100–120/220–240 V
European version : 230 V)
Ground
Transceiver
REMOTE
Remote control cable (supplied with the IC-PW1/EURO)
ACC cable (supplied with the IC-PW1/EURO)
Be sure to connect the cable
to the 7-pin ACC(2) jack.
Coaxial cable
(supplied with the IC-PW1/EURO)
Coaxial cable
(optional)
Connect
[INPUT2]
if necessary
CONNECTING A NON-ICOM LINEAR AMPLIFIER
R WARNING:
Set the transceiver output power and linear amplifier
ALC output level referring to the linear amplifier in-
struction manual.
The ALC input level must be in the range 0 V to –4 V,
and the transceiver does not accept positive voltage.
Non-matched ALC and RF power settings could cause
a fire or ruin the linear amplifier.
The specifications for the SEND relay are 16 V DC
0.5 A. If this level is exceeded, a large external relay
must be used.
RF OUTPUT RF INPUT
ALC
SEND
50 coaxial
cable
Transceiver
ANT1 ALC SEND
To an
antenna
Non-Icom linear amplifier
18
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
2
External antenna tuner connection
CONNECTING THE AH-4/AH-3
The AH-4 or AH-3 must be connected to [ANT1].
Coaxial cable (from the AH-4 or AH-3)
ANT1
Control cable
Transceiver
Ground
AH-4 or AH-3
Long wire or optional AH-2b
(Front panel view)
CAUTION: DO NOT short pin 2 to ground as this
can damage the internal 8 V regulator.
NOTE: DC voltage is applied to pin 1 for micro-
phone operation. Take care when using a non-Icom
microphone.
y GND (PTT ground)
t PTT
r Main readout squelch switch
q Microphone input
w +8 V DC output
e Frequency up/down
u GND
(Microphone ground)
i Main readout AF output
(varies with [AF]/[BAL])
[MIC]
FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
Pin No.
w +8 V DC output Max. 10 mA
e
Frequency up Ground
Frequency down Ground through 470
r
Squelch open “Low” level
Squelch closed “High” level
Microphone connector information
When 2 to 13.8 V is applied to pin 6 of [ACC(2)], the
[XVERT] jack is activated for transverter operation
and the antenna connectors do not receive or trans-
mit any signals. (p. 20)
While receiving, the [XVERT] jack can be activated
as an input terminal from an external transverter.
While transmitting, the [XVERT] jack outputs signals
of the displayed frequency at –20 dBm (22 mV) as
signals for the external transverter.
Transverter jack
Transverter jack information
19
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
AF input
Ground (GND)
PTT
SQUELCH input*
RTTY keying
* Connect the SQUELCH line when required.
Terminal unit (TU) or
Terminal Node Controller (TNC)
[ACC(1)] socket
(Rear panel view)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AFSK output
AF input
Ground (GND)
Ground (GND)
PTT
SQUELCH input*
* Connect the SQUELCH line when required.
Terminal Node Controller (TNC)
or Scan converter
[ACC(1)] socket
(Rear panel view)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
AF input
Ground (GND)
AFSK output
PTT
SQUELCH input*
* Connect the SQUELCH line when required.
Terminal Node Controller (TNC)
or Scan converter
[MIC] connector
(Front panel view)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
FSK and AFSK (SSTV) connections
To connect a terminal unit, TNC or scan converter,
refer to the diagram below.
For RTTY operation:
Narrow filter settings may not pass RTTY signals.
Be sure to select the appropriate IF filter settings
corresponding to the signal width. (p. 61)
FSK (RTTY) connection
Use RTTY mode for
operation
AFSK and SSTV connections
Use SSB or FM mode
for operation
AFSK and SSTV connections via microphone connector
Use SSB or FM mode
for operation
When connected to the [MIC] connector, [MIC
GAIN] and [AF] control adjustment is required.
20
2
INSTALLATION AND CONNECTIONS
Accessory connector information
If the CW side tone level limit or beep level limit is in
use, the CW side tone or beep tone decreases from
the fixed level when the [AF] control is rotated
above a specified level, respectively. (p. 96)
ACC (1)
PIN No.
NAME DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
“High” level : More than 2.4 V
1RTTY Controls RTTY keying “Low” level : Less than 0.6 V
Output current : Less than 2 mA
2 GND Connects to ground. Connected in parallel with ACC(2) pin 2.
Input/output pin.
Ground level : –0.5 V to 0.8 V
3 SEND Goes to ground when transmitting.
Output current : Less than 20 mA
When grounded, transmits.
Input current (Tx) : Less than 200 mA
Connected in parallel with ACC(2) pin 3.
4 MOD
Modulator input. Input impedance : 10 k
Connects to a modulator. Input level : Approx. 100 mV rms
AF detector output.
Output impedance : 4.7 k
5AFFixed, regardless of [AF] position
Output level : 100–300 mV rms
in default settings. (see notes below)
6 SQLS
Squelch output. SQL open : Less than 0.3 V/5 mA
Goes to ground when squelch opens.
SQL closed : More than 6.0 V/100 µA
7 13.8 V 13.8 V output when power is ON.
Output current : Max. 1 A
Connected in parallel with ACC(2) pin 7.
Control voltage : –4 V to 0 V
8 ALC ALC voltage input. Input impedance : More than 10 k
Connected in parallel with ACC(2) pin 5.
ACC (2)
PIN No.
NAME DESCRIPTION SPECIFICATIONS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
18VRegulated 8 V output.
Output voltage : 8 V ±0.3 V
Output current : Less than 10 mA
2 GND Same as ACC(1) pin 2.
3 SEND Same as ACC(1) pin 3.
4 BAND
Band voltage output.
Output voltage : 0 to 8.0 V
(Varies with amateur band)
5 ALC Same as ACC (1) pin 8.
6TRV
Activates [XVERT] input/output Input impedance : More than 10 k
when “HIGH” voltage is applied. Input voltage : 2 to 13.8 V
7
13.8 V
Same as ACC(1) pin 7.
Rear panel view
Rear panel view
2
Before first applying power, make sure all connections
required for your system are complete by referring to
Section 2. Then, reset the transceiver using the follow-
ing procedure.
Resetting CLEARS all programmed contents in
memory channels and returns programmed values
in set mode to default values.
q Make sure the transceiver power is OFF.
w While pushing [M-CL] and [(F-INP)ENT], push
[POWER] to turn power ON.
The internal CPU is reset.
A/D convertor calibration of the DSP unit starts and it
takes 10 sec.
The transceiver displays its initial VFO frequencies when
resetting is complete.
e Correct the set mode settings after resetting, if de-
sired.
Initial settings
After resetting the transceiver, set controls and
switches as shown in the figure below.
Under cooler temperatures, the LCD may appear
dark and unstable after turning power ON. This is
normal and does not indicate any equipment mal-
function.
CW : Max. clockwise
CCW : Max. counterclockwise
When first applying power (CPU resetting)
[POWER] [F-INP] [M-CL]
*
1
FAST in FM mode.
*
2
Appears in some modes.
[POWER]: OFF
[TUNER], [MONITOR],
[NB], [NR]: OFF
[AF]: Max. CCW
[RF/SQL]: 12 o’clock
[MIC GAIN]: 10–12 o’clock
[RF POWER]: Max. CW
[ANT]: 1
[METER]: Po
[P.AMP]: 1
[ATT]: OFF
[PBT CLR]: OFF
[NOTCH]: OFF
[BAL]: Center [AGC]: MID*
1
[LOCK]: OFF
[COMP]*
2
: OFF WIDE;
[1/4],*
2
[TONE]*
2
: OFF
[VOX],*
2
[BK-IN],*
2
[RTTY FIL]*
2
: OFF
Turn power ON, then check the display. If any of the
following indicators appear, turn them OFF as follows:
Quick tuning step indicator “”: Push [TS].
•1 Hz frequency readout : Push [TS] for 2 sec.
(while quick tuning
step is OFF)
RIT indicator “ : Push [RIT].
TX indicator “ : Push [
TX].
Split indicator “ : Push [SPLIT].
Dualwatch indicator “ : Push
[DUALWATCH].
Twin peak filter indicator “
: Push [RTTY FIL].
Auto notch indicator “ : Push [NOTCH].
Manual notch indicator “ : Push [NOTCH].
MN
AN
TPF
TPF
DUAL-W
DUAL-W
SPLIT
SPLIT
TX
TX
RIT
RIT
3
21
BASIC OPERATION
22
3
BASIC OPERATION
3
VFO description
VFO is an abbreviation of Variable Frequency Oscilla-
tor, and traditionally refers to an oscillator.
The transceivers VFO is somewhat different. The VFO
of the IC-756PROIII acts like a computers window and
can show one frequency and one operating mode.
You can call up a desired frequency to the VFO with
the keypad, memo pad-read switch (see p. 82) or the
memory transfer function (see p. 80). You can also
change the frequency with the tuning dial and select
the operating mode with the mode switches.
During dualwatch or split frequency operation, the sub
VFO is functional (non-outline, non-spotted, larger fre-
quency characters). While pushing [XFC] during split
frequency operation, you can change the transmit
readout frequency with the keypad, memo pad-read
switch or the memory transfer function.
METER
Po
ANT
1
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
VFOVFO
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
1
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
21.076.5021.076.50
qw:pp
12:0012:00
Select
TUNING DIAL
MEMORY
CHANNEL
MODE
SWITCHES
MEMO PAD
KEYPAD
(BAND KEY)
Transfer
Transfer
Transfer
Change
21.295 MHz
28.025 MHz
7.001 MHz
•Differences between VFO mode and memory mode
VFO MODE
VFO shows a frequency and operating mode. If the
frequency or operating mode is changed, the VFO
automatically memorizes the new frequency or new
operating mode.
When a VFO is selected from another band or mem-
ory mode, the frequency and operating mode last
used for that VFO appear.
[EXAMPLE]
MEMORY MODE (pgs. 77–81)
Each memory channel shows a frequency and oper-
ating mode like a VFO. Even if the frequency or mode
is changed, the memory channel does not memorize
the new frequency or operating mode.
When the memory channel is selected from another
memory channel or VFO mode, the memorized fre-
quency and operating mode appear.
[EXAMPLE]
23
3
BASIC OPERATION
Push [VFO/MEMO] to switch between VFO and
memory modes.
•“VFO” appears when VFO mode, or the selected mem-
ory channel number appears when memory mode is
selected beside the frequency readout.
Pushing [VFO/MEMO] for 1 sec. transfers the contents
of the selected memory channel to VFO mode. (p. 80)
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
BPFBPF
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
500 500
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
“VFO” indicator
Memory channel number
[VFO/MEMO]
Selecting VFO/memory mode
Push [MAIN/SUB] to select access to the main or
sub readout.
The sub readout frequency is displayed in outline or
mesh font. The sub readout functions only during split
oeration or dualwatch.
[MAIN/SUB]
Main/Sub band selection
24
3
BASIC OPERATION
3
The triple band stacking register provides 3 memories
in one band. 3 sets of a frequency and operating mode
on each band are automatically stored when used.
If a band key is pushed once, the frequency and oper-
ating mode last used are called up. When the key is
pushed again, another stored frequency and operating
mode are called up.
This function is convenient when you operate 3 oper-
ating modes on one band. For example, one register
is used for a CW frequency, another for an SSB fre-
quency and the other one for an RTTY frequency.
See the table below for a list of the band available and
the default settings for each band.
Band keys
Selecting an operating band
BAND REGISTER 1 REGISTER 2 REGISTER 3
1.8 MHz 1.900000 MHz CW 1.910000 MHz CW 1.915000 MHz CW
3.5 MHz 3.550000 MHz LSB 3.560000 MHz LSB 3.580000 MHz LSB
7 MHz 7.050000 MHz LSB 7.060000 MHz LSB 7.020000 MHz CW
10 MHz 10.120000 MHz CW 10.130000 MHz CW 10.140000 MHz CW
14 MHz 14.100000 MHz USB 14.200000 MHz USB 14.050000 MHz CW
18 MHz 18.100000 MHz USB 18.130000 MHz USB 18.150000 MHz USB
21 MHz 21.200000 MHz USB 21.300000 MHz USB 21.050000 MHz CW
24 MHz 24.950000 MHz USB 24.980000 MHz USB 24.900000 MHz CW
28 MHz 28.500000 MHz USB 29.500000 MHz USB 28.100000 MHz CW
50 MHz 50.100000 MHz USB 50.200000 MHz USB 51.000000 MHz FM
General 15.000000 MHz USB 15.100000 MHz USB 15.200000 MHz USB
q Push [(14)5], then select a frequency and an op-
erating mode.
Frequency and operating mode are memorized in the
first band stacking register.
w Push [(14)5] again, then select another frequency
and operating mode.
This frequency and operating mode are memorized in
the second band stacking register.
e Push [(14)5] again, then select another frequency
and operating mode.
This frequency and operating mode are memorized in
the third band stacking register.
When a fourth frequency and operating mode are se-
lected on a band, the first register set in step q, is over
written.
[Example]: 14 MHz band
1.8 3.5 7
10 14 18
21 24 28
GENE
50
123
4 5 6
789
0
F-INP
ENT
DD
Using the band stacking registers
25
3
BASIC OPERATION
The transceiver has several tuning methods for conve-
nient frequency tuning.
Frequency setting
DD
Direct frequency entry with the keypad
DD
Tuning with the tuning dial
q Push the desired band key on the keypad 1–3
times.
•3 different frequencies can be selected on each band
with the band key. (See previous page “Using the band
stacking register.”)
w Rotate the tuning dial to set the desired frequency.
If the dial lock function is activated, the lock indica-
tor lights, and the tuning dial does not function. In
this case, push [LOCK/SPEECH] to deactivate the
lock function. (p. 65)
METER
Po
ANT
1
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
VFO
VFO
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
1
CW
CW
wq.wot.pp
21.076.50
21.076.50
qw:pp
12:00
12:00
METER
Po
ANT
1
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
VFO
VFO
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
1
CW
CW
wq.wpp.pp
21.076.50
21.076.50
qw:pp
12:00
12:00
Band keys
Tuning dial
The transceiver has a keypad for direct frequency
entry as described right.
q Push [(F-INP)ENT].
•“ ” appears.
w Input the desired frequency.
Push [(GENE)•] to input “ (decimal point)” between
the MHz units and kHz units.
e Push [(F-INP)ENT] to set the input frequency.
•To cancel the input, push [MAIN/SUB] instead of
[(F-INP)ENT].
[EXAMPLES]
Keypad
21.280 21.245
14.025 MHz
1 04 2 5
08 7 2 5
7 0 6
2 4 5
18.0725 MHz
1
706 kHz
F-INP
F-INP
15
5.100 MHz
7
7.000 MHz
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
26
3
BASIC OPERATION
3
DD
Quick tuning step
The operating frequency can be changed in kHz
steps (0.1, 1, 5, 9, 10, 12.5, 20 or 25 kHz selectable)
for quick tuning.
q Push [TS] momentarily to turn the quick tuning
function ON.
•“Z” appears when the quick tuning function ON.
w Rotate the tuning dial to change the frequency in
programmed kHz steps.
e Push [TS] again to turn the quick tuning function
OFF.
•“Z” disappears.
r Rotate the tuning dial for normal tuning, if desired.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
TXTX
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
21.076.5021.076.50
VFOVFO
USBUSB
1
METER
Po
ANT
1
qw:pp
12:0012:00
Quick tuning indicator
[TS]
Tuning dial
DD
Selecting “kHz” step
q Push [TS] momentarily to turn the quick tuning
step ON.
•“Z” appears when the quick tuning function ON.
w Push [TS] for 1 sec. to enter the tuning step set-
ting display.
Selected tuning steps for all modes appear.
e Select the desired operating mode.
r Rotate the tuning dial to select the desired tuning
step from 0.1, 1, 5, 9, 10, 12.5, 20 or 25 kHz.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to return to the default set-
ting, if desired.
t Repeat steps e and r to select quick tuning
steps for other modes, if desired.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the setting display.
DEFDEF
TSTS
FMFMAMAM
1010
(kHz)(kHz)
1111
SSBSSB CWCW RTTYRTTY
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
[TS]
Tuning dial
Mode selection
27
3
BASIC OPERATION
DD
Selecting 1 Hz step
The minimum tuning step of 1 Hz can be used for fine
tuning.
q Push [TS] to turn OFF the quick tuning step.
•“” does not appear.
w Push [TS] for 1 sec. to turn the 1 Hz tuning step
ON and OFF.
•RIT and/or TX also functions in 1 Hz tuning step when
used.
SCOPESCOPE
VOICEVOICE
MEMORYMEMORY
SCANSCAN
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
1
TXTX
VFOVFO
1
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.ppp
qr.wpt.ppp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
ATTATT
0FF0FF
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ANTANT
1
qw:pp
12:00
1 Hz step indicator
[TS]
Tuning dial
DD
1
4 tuning function (SSB data/CW/RTTY only)
While operating in SSB data/CW/RTTY, the
1
4 tuning
function is available for critical tuning. Dial rotation is
reduced to
1
4 of normal when the
1
4 function is in
use.
Push [1/4] to toggle the
1
4 function ON and OFF.
1/4
OFF
1/4
ON
1
4 tuning function OFF
1
4 tuning function ON
[1/4]
28
3
BASIC OPERATION
3
DD
Auto tuning step function
When rotating the tuning dial rapidly, the tuning speed
accelerated automatically as selected.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. to select the set mode
menu screen.
e Push [(F-5)OTHERS] to enter miscellaneous (oth-
ers) set mode.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select “MAIN DIAL
Auto TS.”
t Rotate the tuning dial to select the desired condi-
tion from high, low and OFF.
High: Approx. 5 times faster
Low: Approx. twise faster
OFF: Auto tuning step is turned OFF
y Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the set mode.
OTHERS OTHERS
SETSET
é
è
DEFDEF
WIDEWIDE
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
MemopadNumbers OFF
MAIN DIAL Auto TS HIGH
MIC UP/Down Speed HIGH
Quick RIT/TX Clear OFF
SSB/CW Synchronous Tuning OFF
CW Normal Side LSB
External Keypad Auto
Tuning dial
[(F-2)Z] [(F-5)OTHERS]
[(F-1)Y] [EXIT/SET]
DD
Band edge warning beep
When selecting a frequency, that lies outside of a
band’s specified frequency range, a warning beep
sounds.
This function can be turned OFF in set mode, if de-
sired.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. to select the set mode
menu screen.
e Push [(F-5)OTHERS] to enter miscellaneous (oth-
ers) set mode.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select “Beep (Band
Edge).”
t Rotate the tuning dial to turn the band edge warn-
ing beep ON and OFF.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the set mode.
OTHERS OTHERS
SETSET
é
è
DEFDEF
WIDEWIDE
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
Beep(Confirmation) ON
Beep(Band Edge) ON
RF/SQL Control RF+SQL
Quick Dualwatch ON
Quick SPLIT ON
FM SPLIT Offset(HF) -0.100MHz
FM SPLIT Offset(50M) -0.100MHz
Tuning dial
[(F-2)Z] [(F-5)OTHERS]
[(F-1)Y] [EXIT/SET]
29
3
BASIC OPERATION
Operating mode selection
SSB (LSB/USB), SSB data (LSB-D/USB-D), CW, CW
reverse (CW-R), RTTY, RTTY reverse (RTTY-R), AM,
AM data (AM-D), FM and FM data (FM-D) are avail-
able in the IC-756PROIII. Select the desired operation
mode as follows.
To select a mode of operation, push the desired mode
switch momentarily. Push the switch again to toggle
between USB and LSB, CW/CW-R and RTTY/RTTY-
R, AM and FM, if necessary. Push the switch for 1 sec.
to toggle between CW and CW-R, RTTY and RTTY-R,
or to select data mode, if necessary.
See the diagram below left for the order of selection.
Microphone signals are muted when data mode is
selected.
Selecting SSB mode
Push [SSB] to select USB or LSB.
USB is selected first when above 10 MHz; or LSB is se-
lected first when below 10 MHz operation.
After USB or LSB is selected, push [SSB] to toggle be-
tween USB and LSB.
After USB or LSB is selected, push [SSB] for 1 sec. to
select USB-D or LSB-D mode, respectively.
Selecting CW/RTTY mode
Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW or RTTY.
•After CW or RTTY is selected, push [CW/RTTY] to tog-
gle between CW and RTTY.
•After CW or RTTY is selected, push [CW/RTTY] for
1 sec. to toggle between CW and CW reverse, or, RTTY
and RTTY reverse mode, respectively.
Selecting AM/FM mode
Push [AM/FM] to select AM or FM.
After AM or FM is selected, push [AM/FM] to toggle be-
tween AM and FM.
After AM or FM is selected, push [AM/FM] for 1 sec. to
select AM-D or FM-D mode, respectively.
Mode selection
SSB
CW/RTTY
AM/FM
USB-D USB
CW-R CW
AM-D AM
Push mode switch
for 1 sec.
Push mode switch
momentarily.
LSB LSB-D
RTTY RTTY-R
FM FM-D
Volume setting
Rotate [AF] control clockwise to increase; counter-
clockwise to decrease the audio output level.
Set a suitable audio level.
Audio output
increases
Audio output
decreases
[AF]
30
3
BASIC OPERATION
3
Squelch and receive (RF) sensitivity
Adjusts the RF gain and squelch threshold level. The
squelch removes noise output from the speaker
(closed position) when no signal is received.
The squelch is particularly effective for FM. It is also avail-
able for other modes.
12 to 1 o’clock position is recommended for any setting of
the [RF/SQL] control.
The control can be set as ‘Auto’ (RF gain control in SSB,
CW and RTTY; squelch control in AM and FM) or squelch
control (RF gain is fixed at maximum) in set mode as fol-
lows. (p. 99)
Adjusting RF gain (Receive sensitivity)
Normally, [RF/SQL] is set to the 11 o’clock position.
Rotate [RF/SQL] to the 11 o’clock position for maxi-
mum sensitivity.
Rotating counterclockwise from the maximum position re-
duces sensitivity.
The S-meter indicates receive sensitivity.
Adjusting squelch (Removing non-signal noise)
Rotate [RF/SQL] clockwise when receiving no signal,
until the noise just disappears.
[RX] indicator light goes out.
Rotating [RF/SQL] past the threshold point invokes the S-
meter squelch— this allows you to set a minimum signal
level needed to open the squelch.
When setting as RF gain/squelch control
When functioning as RF gain control
(Squelch is fixed open; SSB, CW, RTTY only)
When functioning as squelch control
(RF gain is fixed at maximum.)
While rotating the RF gain control, noise may be
heard. This comes from the DSP unit and does not
indicate an equipment malfunction.
Squelch is
open.
S-meter
squelch
S-meter squelch
threshold
Noise squelch
threshold
(FM mode)
Shallow Deep
Noise squelch (FM mode)
Minimum RF gain
Adjustable
range
Maximum
RF gain
Recommended level
RF gain
adjustable
range
Maximum
RF gain
S-meter
squelch
Noise squelch (FM mode)
Squelch is
open.
[RF/SQL]
SET MODE OPERATION
RF+SQL
Can be used in all modes.
(default)
Functions as noise squelch or S-meter
squelch in AM and FM modes; S-
meter squelch only in other modes.
SQL
Operates as a squelch control.
RF gain is fixed at maximum sensitivity.
Operates as an RF gain control in
SSB, CW and RTTY modes.
AUTO
Squelch is fixed open.
Operates as a squelch control in AM
and FM modes.
RF gain is fixed at maximum sensitivity.
31
3
BASIC OPERATION
Meter function
The transceiver has 4 transmit meter functions for your
convenience. Select the desired meter with the
[METER] switch.
Analog transmit meter
Push [METER] to select RF power (Po), SWR, ALC
or compression level (COMP).
In addition, the transceiver can display the multi-func-
tion digital meter in the LCD display, which displays all
transmit meters simultaneously.
Multi-function digital meter
q Push [METER] for 1 sec. to turn the multi-function
digital meter ON.
w Push [(F-1)P-HOLD] to toggle the peak level hold
function ON or OFF.
•“P-HOLD” appears on the window title when the peak
level hold function is turned ON.
e Push [METER] for 1 sec. or push [EXIT/SET] to
turn the multi-function digital meter OFF.
P-HOLDP-HOLD
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
.1...3...5...7...9..1...3...5...7...9.....+20+20......+40+40......+60dB+60dB
0∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑2525∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑50 ∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑∑ 100%100%
1 1.51.5 2 2.52.5 3
S
PoPo
ALCALC
COMPCOMP
SWRSWR
P-HOLDP-HOLD MULTI-FUNCTION METERMULTI-FUNCTION METER
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
0 5 10 15 2020 dB
qw:pp
12:0012:00
[METER]
DISPLAY
MEASUREMENT
INDICATION
Po
Indicates the relative RF output power in %.
SWR
Indicates the SWR over the transmission
line.
ALC
Indicates the ALC level. When the meter
movement shows the input signal level ex-
ceeds the allowable level, the ALC limits
the RF power. In such cases, reduce the
[MIC GAIN] control.
COMP
Indicates the compression level when the
speech compressor is in use.
SWR reading
The SWR meter indicates the SWR over the transmis-
sion line in all modes.
q Push [TUNER] to turn the antenna tuner OFF.
w Push [METER] several times to select the Po
meter.
e Push [CW/RTTY] once or twice to select RTTY
mode.
r Push [TRANSMIT].
t Rotate [RF POWER] clockwise past the 12 o’clock
position for more than 30 W output power (30%).
y Push [METER] once to select the SWR meter as
the transmit meter.
u Read the SWR on the SWR meter.
The built-in antenna tuner matches the transmitter
to the antenna when the SWR is lower than 3:1.
SWR
S
COMP
ALC
Po
0
10
10
25 50
100
20
1
0
1. 5
2
3
1
5
9
+20
+40
+60dB
dB
SWR meter
Less than 1.5:1
DD
Microphone gain adjustment
32
3
BASIC OPERATION
3
Basic transmit operation
Before transmitting, monitor your selected operating
frequency to make sure transmitting won’t cause in-
terference to other stations on the same frequency.
q Push [METER] to select the ALC meter.
w Push [PTT] (microphone) to transmit.
•Talk into the microphone at your normal voice level.
e While talking into the microphone, rotate [MIC
GAIN] so that the ALC meter reading doesn’t go
outside the ALC zone.
r Release [PTT] (microphone) to return to receive.
In addition, the transceiver can display the multi-func-
tion digital meter in the LCD display, which displays
all transmit meters simultaneously.
SWR
S
COMP
ALC
Po
0
10
10
25 50
100
20
1
0
1. 5
2
3
1
5
9
+20
+40
+60dB
dB
ALC zone
[METER]
[MIC GAIN]
Before transmitting, monitor your selected oper-
ating frequency to make sure transmitting won’t
cause interference to other stations on the same
frequency. It’s good Amateur practice to listen
first, and then, even if nothing is heard, ask “is
the frequency in use” once or twice, before you
being operating on that frequency.
DD
Transmitting
Before transmitting, monitor your selected operating
frequency to make sure transmitting won’t cause in-
terference to other stations on the same frequency.
q Push [TRANSMIT] or [PTT] (microphone) to trans-
mit.
The [TX] indicator lights red.
w Push [TRANSMIT] again or release [PTT] (micro-
phone) to return to receive.
Adjusting the transmit output power
Rotate [RF POWER].
Adjustable range: 5 W to 100 W
(AM mode: 5 W to 40 W)
Increases
max. 100 W
(40 W for AM)
Decreases
min. 5 W
[TRANSMIT]
[TX] indicator[RF POWER]
D Convenient functions for receive
4
33
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
Operating SSB
q Push a band key to select the desired band.
w Push [SSB] to select LSB or USB.
“LSB” or “USB” appears.
Below 10 MHz LSB is automatically selected; above
10 MHz USB is automatically selected.
e Rotate the tuning dial to tune a desired signal.
The S-meter indicates received signal strength when
signal is received.
r Rotate [AF] to set audio to a comfortable listening
level.
t Push [TRANSMIT] or [PTT] (microphone) to trans-
mit.
The TX indicator lights red.
y Speak into the microphone at your normal voice
level.
Adjust the microphone gain with [MIC GAIN] at this step,
if necessary.
u Push [TRANSMIT] or release [PTT] (microphone)
to return to receive.
[TRANSMIT]
[SSB]
[AF] [MIC GAIN] Tuning dial
[TX] indicator [RX] indicator Band keys
Preamp (p. 57)
Push [P.AMP] several times to set the preamp
OFF, preamp 1 ON or preamp 2 ON.
•“P.AMP1” or “P.AMP2” appears when the preamp 1 or
preamp 2 is set to ON, respectively. (depending on
operating frequency band)
Attenuator (p. 57)
Push [ATT] several times to set the attenuator in
6 dB steps.
•“ATT” and attenuation level appear when the attenua-
tor is set to ON.
Noise blanker (p. 64)
Push [NB] switch to turn the noise blanker ON
and OFF.
Noise blanker indicator (in [NB] switch) lights when
the noise blanker is set to ON.
Push [NB] for 1 sec. to enter the noise blanker
level set mode, then rotate the tuning dial to ad-
just the threshold level.
•Twin PBT (passband tuning) (p. 60)
Rotate [TWIN PBT] controls (inner/outer).
Push [PBT CLR] to clear the settings.
Noise reduction (p. 65)
Push [NR] switch to turn the noise reduction ON
and OFF.
Rotate [NR] control to adjust the noise reduction level.
Noise reduction indicator (in [NR] switch) lights when
the noise reduction is set to ON.
Notch filter (p. 64)
Push [NOTCH] switch to turn the auto or manual
notch function ON and OFF.
Rotate [NOTCH] control to set the attenuating fre-
quency for manual notch operation.
Notch indicator (in [NOTCH] switch) lights when either
the auto or manual notch is set to ON.
AGC (auto gain control) (p. 59)
Push [AGC] switch several times to select
AGC FAST, AGC MID or AGC SLOW.
Push [AGC] for 1 sec. to enter the AGC set
mode.
Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the time constant.
34
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
D Convenient functions for transmit
Speech compressor (p. 68)
Push [COMP] to turn the speech compressor ON
and OFF.
Pushing [COMP] for 1 sec. to select the compression
bandwidth from wide, middle and narrow.
•Transmit quality monitor (p. 70)
Push [MONITOR] to turn the monitor function ON
and OFF.
Monitor indicator (in [MONITOR] switch) lights when
the monitor function is set to ON.
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select the monitor level item
with [(F-1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial
to adjust the monitor gain.
•VOX (voice operated transmit) (p. 66)
Push [VOX] to turn the VOX function ON and
OFF.
•“VOX ON” appears when the VOX function is set to
ON.
Audio tone control (p. 95)
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select an item with [(F-
1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial to adjust
the audio tone.
DD
About 5 MHz band operation (USA version only)
Operation on the 5 MHz band is allowed on 5 discrete
frequencies and must adhere to the following:
USB mode
Maximum of 50 watts ERP
(Effective Radiated Power)
2.8 kHz bandwidth
It is the operators responsibility to set all controls so
that the transmission in this band meets the stringent
conditions under which we may use these frequencies.
NOTE: We recommend that you store these fre-
quencies, mode and filter settings into the memory
channel for easy recall.
*The channel center frequencies that are specified
by the FCC, show the center frequency of their
passband. However, the IC-756PROIII displays
carrier point frequency, so set 1.5 kHz below from
FCC channel center frequency.
4
IC-756PROIII Tuning FCC Channel
Frequency* Center Frequency*
5.33050 MHz 5.33200 MHz
5.34650 MHz 5.34800 MHz
5.36650 MHz 5.36800 MHz
5.37150 MHz 5.37300 MHz
5.40350 MHz 5.40500 MHz
To assist you in operating the 5 MHz band correctly
within the rules specified by the FCC, transmission
is impossible on any 5 MHz band frequency other
than the 5 frequencies indicated in the table above.
35
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Convenient functions for receive
Operating CW
q Push a band key to select the desired band.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW.
After CW mode is selected, push [CW/RTTY] for 1 sec.
to toggle between CW and CW-R modes.
“CW” or “CW-R” appears.
e Rotate the tuning dial to simultaneously tune a de-
sired signal and its side tone.
The S-meter indicates received signal strength when
signal is received.
r Rotate [AF] to set audio to a comfortable listening
level.
t Push [TRANSMIT] to transmit.
The TX indicator lights red.
y Use the electric keyer or paddle to key your CW sig-
nals.
The power meter indicates transmittted CW output
power.
u Adjust CW speed with [KEY SPEED].
Adjustable within 6-60 WPM.
i Push [TRANSMIT] to return to receive.
[CW/RTTY][AF] [KEY SPEED] Tuning dial
[TRANSMIT] [TX] indicator [RX] indicator Band keys
Preamp (p. 57)
Push [P.AMP] several times to set the preamp
OFF, preamp 1 ON or preamp 2 ON.
•“P.AMP1” or “P.AMP2” appears when the preamp 1 or
preamp 2 is set to ON, respectively. (depending on
operating frequency band)
Attenuator (p. 57)
Push [ATT] several times to set the attenuator in
6 dB steps.
•“ATT” and attenuation level appear when the attenua-
tor is set to ON.
Noise blanker (p. 64)
Push [NB] switch to turn the noise blanker ON
and OFF.
Noise blanker indicator (in [NB] switch) lights when
the noise blanker is set to ON.
Push [NB] for 1 sec. to enter the noise blanker
level set mode, then rotate the tuning dial to ad-
just the threshold level.
•Twin PBT (passband tuning) (p. 60)
Rotate [TWIN PBT] controls (inner/outer).
Push [PBT CLR] to clear the settings.
Noise reduction (p. 65)
Push [NR] switch to turn the noise reduction ON
and OFF.
Rotate [NR] control to adjust the noise reduction level.
Noise reduction indicator (in [NR] switch) lights when
the noise reduction is set to ON.
Notch filter (p. 64)
Push [NOTCH] switch to turn the manual notch
function ON and OFF.
Rotate [NOTCH] control to set the attenuating fre-
quency for manual notch operation.
Notch indicator (in [NOTCH] switch) lights when the
manual notch is set to ON.
AGC (auto gain control) (p. 59)
Push [AGC] switch several times to select
AGC FAST, AGC MID or AGC SLOW.
Push [AGC] for 1 sec. to enter the AGC set
mode.
Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the time constant.
1
4 function (p. 27)
Push [1/4] to turn the
1
4 function ON and OFF.
36
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Convenient functions for transmit
Break-in function (p. 67)
Push [BK-IN] several times to select the break-in
OFF, semi break-in and full break-in.
•“BK-IN SEMI” or “BK-IN FULL” appears when the
semi break-in or full break-in function is set to ON, re-
spectively.
DD
About CW reverse mode
CW-R (CW Reverse) mode receives CW signals with
a reverse side CW carrier point like that of LSB and
USB modes.
Use when interfering signals are near a desired signal
and you want to change the interference tone.
q Push [CW/RTTY] once or twice to select CW
mode.
w Push [CW/RTTY] for 1 sec. to select CW or CW-R
mode.
Check the interfering tone.
Push
for 1 sec.
BFO
CW-R mode (USB side)
BFO
Desired signal
CW mode (LSB side)
Interference
Desired signalInterference
CW/RTTY
[CW/RTTY]
4
DD
CW side tone function
When the transceiver is in the receive condition (and
the break-in function is OFF— p. 67) you can listen to
the tone of your CW signal without actually transmit-
ting.
This allows you to match your transmit signal exactly
to another station’s. This also convenient for CW
practice.
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select an item with [(F-
1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial to adjust
the side tone level.
Tuning dial
[EXIT/SET]
[(F-1)Y] [(F-2)Z]
37
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
About CW pitch control
The received CW audio pitch and monitored CW
audio can be adjusted to suit your preference (300 to
900 Hz in 25 Hz steps) without changing the operat-
ing frequency.
Rotate [CW PITCH] to suit your preference.
Adjustable within 300 to 900 Hz in 25 Hz steps.
The filter set mode screen graphically displays the
CW pitch operations. (See at left.)
FILTER
FILTER
CW
CW
FI
FI
L 1
FI
FI
L 2
FI
FI
L 3
1.2k
1.2k
500
500
250
250
PBT2
PBT2
PBT1
PBT1
450 700 950
450 700 950
BK-IN
BK-IN
OFF
OFF
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
1/4
1/4
OFF
OFF
BW
BW
DEF
DEF
[CW PITCH]
Higher
Frequency
Lower
frequency
38
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
4
Electronic CW keyer
The IC-756PROIII has a number of convenient func-
tions for the electronic keyer that can be accessed
from the memory keyer menu.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW mode.
e Push [(F-3)KEYER] then [EXIT/SET] to select
memory keyer menu screen.
r Push one of the multi-function keys ([F-1] to [F-4])
to select the desired menu. See the diagram
below.
Push [EXIT/SET] to return to the previous indication.
[CW/RTTY] [EXIT/SET]
[(F-1)]–[(F-4)]
F-1 F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
MEMORY KEYERMEMORY KEYER
MEMORY KEYER MENUMEMORY KEYER MENU
SEND Max.55 Characters SEND Max.55 Characters 4ch 4ch
EDIT Memory Editor EDIT Memory Editor
001 001 Style Contest Number 001 001 Style Contest Number
CW KEY Memo-key,Elec-key,CW Wave Form Set CW KEY Memo-key,Elec-key,CW Wave Form Set
¡Memory keyer menu screen
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
MEMORY KEYERMEMORY KEYER
CQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOMCQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOM
TESTTEST
QRZ?QRZ?
M1M1
M2M2
M3M3
M4M4
CFM TUCFM TU
UR 5NNUR 5NN001001 BK BK
¡Memory keyer send screen
ABCABC
123123
MEMORY KEYERMEMORY KEYER
CQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOMCQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOM
TESTTEST
QRZ?QRZ?
M1M1
M2M2
M3M3
M4M4
CFM TUCFM TU
UR 5NNUR 5NN001001 BK BK
ABCABC
¡Memory keyer edit screen
KEYER 001KEYER 001
Number StyleNumber Style NormalNormal
CounCount Up Triggert Up Trigger M2M2
Present NumberPresent Number 001001
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
¡Contest number set mode
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
KEYER CW-KEYKEYER CW-KEY
Keyer Repeat TimeKeyer Repeat Time 2s2s
Dot/Dash RatioDot/Dash Ratio 1:1:3.01:1:3.0
Rise TimeRise Time 4ms4ms
Paddle PolarityPaddle Polarity NormalNormal
Keyer TypeKeyer Type ELEC-KEYELEC-KEY
MIC Up/Down KeyerMIC Up/Down Keyer OFFOFF
¡Keyer set mode screen
F-1 F-2
F-1
F-2
F-3
F-3
F-4
F-4
F-5
21. 085. 0021. 085. 00
1
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
0FF0FF
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
BWBW
500500
SFTSFT
VFOVFO
FIL2FIL2
12:00
CWCW
qw:pp
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1
21. 085. 0021. 085. 00
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
CW
CW
CW
CW
BPF
EXIT/SET
SCOPESCOPE
VOICEVOICE
KEYER
MEMORYMEMORY
SCANSCAN
M1M1
M2M2
M3M3
M4M4
-1-1
é
è
DEFDEF
é
è
DEFDEF
ç
å
DELDEL
SPACESPACE
M1..M4M1..M4
SENDSEND
EDITEDIT
001001
CW KEYCW KEY
0
qr.qpp.pp
qr.qpp.pp
39
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Memory keyer send screen
Pre-set characters can be sent using the keyer send
menu. Contents of the memory keyer are set using
the edit menu.
•Transmitting
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW mode.
e Push [(F-3)KEYER] to select the memory keyer
screen.
r Push [TRANSMIT] to set the transceiver to trans-
mit, or set the break-in function ON (p.67).
t Push [(F-1)M1] [(F-4)M4] momentarily to trans-
mit the contents one time; push these keys for 1
sec. to transmit the contents repeatedly.
•“M1”–“M4” are highlighted while transmitting.
•“ ” appears while transmitting repeatedly.
Set the repeat interval of the memory keyer to 1–60 sec.
(1 sec. steps). See p. 42 for keyer set mode.
•To count down the contact number, push [
(F-5)–1].
For your information
When an external keypad is connected to the pin 3
and pin 7 of the [MIC] connecter, the programmed
contents, M1–M4, can be transmitted without open-
ing the memory keyer screen.
See page 104 for details.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the memory keyer
screen.
MEMORY KEYER
MEMORY KEYER
M1
M1
M2
M2
M3
M3
M4
M4
CQ
CQ
TEST
TEST
CQ
CQ
TEST
TEST
DE
DE
ICOM
ICOM
ICOM
ICOM
TEST
TEST
QRZ?
QRZ?
CFM
CFM
TU
TU
UR
UR
5NN
5NN
001
001
BK
BK
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
1/4
1/4
OFF
OFF
BK-IN
BK-IN
OFF
OFF
M1
M1
M2
M2
M3
M3
M4
M4
-1
-1
[CW/RTTY]
[TRANSMIT]
[EXIT/SET]
[(F-1)M1]–[(F-4)M4]
40
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Editing a memory keyer
4
The contents of the momory keyer memories can be
set using the memory keyer edit menu. The memory
keyer can memorize and re-transmit 4 CW key codes
for often-used CW sentences, contest number, etc.
Total capacity of the memory keyer is 70 characters
per memory channel.
• Pre-programmed contents
•Programming contents
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW mode.
e Push [(F-3)KEYER] then [EXIT/SET] to select
keyer set mode.
r Push [(F-2)EDIT] to enter the keyer edit screen.
t Push [(F-5)M1..M4] several times to select the de-
sired keyer memory channel.
y Select the desired character group by pushing the
character group keys ([ABC], [123] or [etc]) sev-
eral times.
[etc] appears when [123] is pushed when “123” char-
acter group is selected.
Selectabel characters (with the tuning dial);
NOTE:
^” is used to transmit a following word with no
space such as
AR
. Put “^” before a text string
such as ^AR, and the string “ ” is sent with
no space.
” is used to insert the CW contest number.
The contest number automatically increments
by 1. This function is only available for one
memory keyer channel at a time. Memory
keyer channel M2 used “” by default.
u Select the desired character by rotating the tuning
dial or by pushing the band key for number input.
Push [(F-1)
] or [(F-2)
] for cursor movement.
Push [(F-3)DEL] to delete the selected character.
Push [(F-4)SPACE] to input a space.
•“*” is for contact numbers and can be input for the
count up trigger channel (“ ” appears).
i Repeat step u until the desired contents are input.
o Push [(F-5)M1..M4] to select the next memory
channel and repeat step u for character input, if
desired.
!0 Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the keyer set mode.
AR
Key selection
ABC
ABC
Editable characters
A to Z (capital leters)
123
123
0 to 9 (numbers)
/ ?
^
. , @
etc
etc
CH Contents
CQ TEST CQ TEST DE ICOM ICOM TEST
UR 5NN BK
CFM TU
M1
M2
M3
QRZ?
M4
ç
å
DEL
DEL
SPACE
SPACE
M1..M4
M1..M4
KEYER EDIT
KEYER EDIT
M1
M1
M2
M2
M3
M3
M4
M4
CQ
CQ
TEST
TEST
CQ
CQ
TEST
TEST
DE
DE
ICOM
ICOM
ICOM
ICOM
TEST
TEST
QRZ?
QRZ?
CFM
CFM
TU
TU
UR
UR
5NN
5NN
001
001
BK
BK
ABC
ABC
ABC
ABC
123
123
Character
group
keys
Selected
character
Memory ch
select
[(F-2)][(F-1)]
[123]/[etc] [ABC]
[EXIT/SET] [(F-5)M1..M4]
[(F-3)DEL] [(F-4)SPACE]
41
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Contest number set mode
CCoouunntt UUpp TTrriiggggeerr
(Count up trigger)
This selects which of the three memory slots will have
the contest serial number exchange. The count up
trigger allows the serial number automatically incre-
mented after each complete serial number exchange
is sent.
•M1, M2, M3 and M4 can be set. (default: M2)
NNuummbbeerr SSttyyllee
(Number style)
This item sets the numbering system used for contest
(serial) numbers— normal or morse cut numbers.
Normal : Does not use morse cut number
(default)
190ANO : Sets 1 as A, 9 as N and 0 as O.
190 ANT : Sets 1 as A, 9 as N and 0 as T.
90 NT : Sets 9 as N and 0 as O.
90 NT : Sets 9 as N and 0 as T.
PPrreesseenntt NNuummbbeerr
(Present number)
This item shows the current number for the count up
trigger channel set above.
Rotate the tuning dial to change the number, or push
[(F-3)001CLR] for 1sec. to reset the current number
to 001.
This menu is used to set the contest (serial) number
and count up trigger, etc.
Setting the contact (serial) number
Contact number can be automatically transmitted
from one of the memory keyer channels. The Morse
cut numbers can be used as the contact numbers.
The maximum number for contact numbers is 9999.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW mode.
e Push [(F-3)KEYER] then [EXIT/SET] to select
keyer set mode.
r Push [(F-3)001] to select contest number set
mode.
t
Push
[(F-1)
YY
]
or
[(F-2)
ZZ
]
to select the desired set
item.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select the default condi-
tion or value.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the keyer set mode.
KEYER 001KEYER 001
NumberNumberStyleStyle
NormalNormal
CounCount UPUP TriggerTrigger M2M2
PresentPresent NumberNumber 001001
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1/41/4
OFFOFF
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
é
è
DEFDEF
[(F-2)][(F-1)] [EXIT/SET]
[(F-3)DEL]
42
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Keyer set mode
KKeeyyeerr RReeppeeaatt TTiimmee
(Keyer repeat time)
When sending CW using the repeat timer, this item
sets the time between transmission.
•1 to 60 sec. in 1 sec. steps can be selected.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default setting.
(default: 2 sec.)
DDoott//DDaasshh RRaattiioo
(Dot/Dash ratio)
This item sets the dot/dash ratio.
•1:1:2.8 to 1:1:4.5 can be set.
Check the ratio with side tone in CW mode.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default ratio
of 1:1:3.0.
Keying weight example: Morse code “K”
DASH
Weight setting:
1:1:3 (default)
Weight setting:
Adjusted
DASH
DOT (Fixed*)
Adjustable range SPACE (Fixed*)
*SPACE and DOT length can be adjusted with
[KEY SPEED] only.
4
This set mode is used to set the memory keyer repeat
time, dash weight, paddle specifications, keyer type,
etc.
Setting the electronic keyer
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW mode.
e Push [(F-3)KEYER] then [EXIT/SET] to select
keyer set mode.
r Push [(F-4)CW KEY] to select memory keyer set
mode.
t Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the desired set
item.
y Set the desired condition using the tuning dial.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default condition
or value.
u Push [EXIT/SET] twice to normal screen.
DEFDEF
KEYER CW-KEYKEYER CW-KEY
é
è
KeyerKeyer RepeatRepeatTimeTime 2s 2s
Dot/DashDot/Dash RatioRatio 1:1:3.01:1:3.0
RiseRiseTimeTime 4ms4ms
PaddlePaddlePolarityPolarity NormalNormal
KeyerKeyer TypeType ELEC-KEYELEC-KEY
MICMIC Up/DownUp/Down KeyerKeyer OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1/41/4
OFFOFF
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
[(F-2)][(F-1)] [EXIT/SET]
[(F-3)DEL]
43
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Keyer set mode (continued)
RRiissee TTiimmee
(Rise time)
This item sets the envelop time period which the out-
put power becomes the set transmit power.
2, 4, 6, or 8 msec. can be selected.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default setting.
(default: 4 sec.)
Key action
Tx output power
• About rise time
Rise time
Tx
Rx
Set Tx power level
Time
0
PPaaddddllee PPoollaarriittyy
(Paddle polarity)
This item sets the paddle polarity.
Normal and reverse pooarity can be selected.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default setting.
(default: Normal)
KKeeyyeerr TTyyppee
(Keyer type)
This item selects the keyer type for [ELEC-KEY] con-
nector on the front panel.
ELEC-KEY, BUG-KEY and Straight key can be se-
lected.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default setting.
(default: ELEC-KEY)
MMIICC UUpp//DDoowwnn KKeeyyeerr
(Microphone’s [UP]/[DN] switches keyer)
This item allows you to set the microphone [UP]/[DN]
switches to be used as a paddle.
•ON : [UP]/[DN] switches can be used for CW.
OFF: [UP]/[DN] switches cannot be used for CW.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default setting.
(default: OFF)
NOTE: When “ON” is selected, the frequency and
memory channel cannot be changed using the
[UP]/[DN] switches.
44
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
4
Operating RTTY (FSK)
When using your RTTY terminal or TNC, consult the
manual that comes with the RTTY terminal or TNC.
q Push a band key to select the desired band.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select RTTY.
After RTTY mode is selected, push [CW/RTTY] for 1
sec. to toggle between RTTY and RTTY-R modes.
•“RTTY” or “RTTY-R” appears.
e Push [(F-3)DECODE] to display the decoder
screen.
The IC-756PROIII has a Baudot decoder.
r Rotate the tuning dial to simultaneously tune a de-
sired signal.
The S-meter indicates received signal strength when
signal is received.
t Push [TRANSMIT] to transmit.
The TX indicator lights red.
y Type from the connected PC’s keyboard to enter
the contents that you want to transmit.
The text color will be changed when transmitted.
•Press one of [F-1] to [F-4] to transmit the TX memory
contents.
u Push [TRANSMIT] to return to receive.
[CW/RTTY][AF] Tuning dial
[TRANSMIT] [TX] indicator [RX] indicator Band keys
DD
Convenient functions for receive
Preamp (p. 57)
Push [P.AMP] several times to set the preamp
OFF, preamp 1 ON or preamp 2 ON.
•“P.AMP1” or “P.AMP2” appears when the preamp 1 or
preamp 2 is set to ON, respectively. (depending on
operating frequency band)
Attenuator (p. 57)
Push [ATT] several times to set the attenuator in
6 dB steps.
•“ATT” and attenuation level appear when the attenua-
tor is set to ON.
Noise blanker (p. 64)
Push [NB] switch to turn the noise blanker ON
and OFF.
Noise blanker indicator (in [NB] switch) lights when
the noise blanker is set to ON.
Push [NB] for 1 sec. to enter the noise blanker
level set mode, then rotate the tuning dial to ad-
just the threshold level.
•Twin PBT (passband tuning) (p. 60)
Rotate [TWIN PBT] controls (inner/outer).
Push [PBT CLR] to clear the settings.
Noise reduction (p. 65)
Push [NR] switch to turn the noise reduction ON
and OFF.
Rotate [NR] control to adjust the noise reduction level.
Noise reduction indicator (in [NR] switch) lights when
the noise reduction is set to ON.
AGC (auto gain control) (p. 59)
Push [AGC] switch several times to select
AGC FAST, AGC MID or AGC SLOW.
Push [AGC] for 1 sec. to enter the AGC set
mode.
Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the time constant.
1
4 function (p. 27)
Push [1/4] to turn the
1
4 function ON and OFF.
DD
RTTY filter/Twin peak filter
45
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
The transceiver has 5 RTTY filters in addition to nor-
mal IF filters. The passband width can be selected
from 1 kHz, 500 Hz, 350 Hz, 300 Hz and 250 Hz.
When the RTTY filter is turned ON, the RTTY tuning
meter can be used. (p. 47)
Moreover, the twin peak filter changes the receive fre-
quency response by boosting 2 particular frequencies
(2125 and 2295 Hz) for better copying of desired RTTY
signals.
q Push [CW/RTTY] once or twice to select RTTY
mode.
w Push [RTTY FIL] to turn the RTTY filter ON.
“TPF” appears when the twin peak filter is turned ON.
•RTTY filter selection
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select RTTY mode.
e Push [RTTY FIL] for 1 sec. to enter RTTY filter set
mode.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] to select band width item.
t Rotate the tuning dial to select the RTTY filter
width from 1 kHz, 500 Hz, 350 Hz, 300 Hz and
250 Hz.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default value.
y Push [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select twin peak filter item.
The received audio volume may become greater when
the twin peak filter is turned ON.
u Rotate the tuning dial to turn the twin peak filter
function ON or OFF.
i Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the RTTY filter set mode.
BWBW
350350
SFTSFT
0
VFOVFO
FIL2FIL2
RTTYRTTY
TXTX
1
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
21.076.5021.076.50
TPFTPF
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
qw:pp
12:0012:00
TPF indicator
[CW/RTTY][RTTY FIL] [EXIT/SET]
DD
About RTTY reverse mode
Received characters are occasionally garbled when
the receive signal is reversed between MARK and
SPACE. This reversal can be caused by incorrect
TNC connections, settings, commands, etc.
To receive a reversed RTTY signal correctly, select
RTTY-R (RTTY Reverse) mode.
q Push [CW/RTTY] once or twice to select RTTY
mode.
w Push [CW/RTTY] for 1 sec. to select RTTY or
RTTY-R mode.
Check the receive signal.
Normal Reverse
Space
Mark
BFO
Space
Mark
BFO
170 Hz 2125 Hz 170 Hz2125 Hz
46
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
4
DD
Functions for the RTTY decoder indication
The transceiver has an RTTY decoder for Baudot
(mark freq.: 2125 Hz, shift freq.: 170 Hz, 45 bps).
An external terminal unit (TU) or terminal node con-
troller (TNC) is not necessary for receiving a Baudot
signal.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select RTTY mode.
e Push [(F-3)DECODE] to turn the RTTY decoder
ON.
•RTTY decoder screen appears.
r If the RTTY filter is turned OFF, push [RTTY FIL]
to turn the function ON.
The RTTY decoder does not function when the RTTY
filter is turned OFF.
t Push [(F-2)HOLD/CLR] momentarily to freeze the
current screen.
“HOLD” appears while the function is in use.
y Push [(F-5)WIDE] to toggle the normal or wide
screen space.
u Push [(F-2)HOLD/CLR] for 1 sec. to clear the dis-
played characters.
i Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the RTTY decoder
screen.
SFTSFT
0
BWBW
350 350
RTTY DECODERTTY DECODE
VFOVFO
VFOVFO
qr≥qot≥pp
14.100.00
RTTY RTTY FILFIL2
RTTY RTTY FILFIL2
TXTX
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1/41/4
OFFOFF
RTTYRTTY
FILFIL
ONON
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
ANTANT
1
<MENU1><MENU1> TX MEMTX MEM
HLD/CLRHLD/CLR
ADJADJ
WIDEWIDE
qw:pp
12:00
********RTTYRTTYDecodeDecodeMonitorMonitor ********
45bps45bpsBAUDOTBAUDOTMark=2125,Mark=2125,Shift=170Shift=170
UnShiftUnShiftOnOn SpaceSpacesupportsupport(SET-OTHERS)(SET-OTHERS)
NewNew LineLineCodeCodeselectableselectable(SET-OTHERS)(SET-OTHERS)
IfIfRTTY-FILRTTY-FILisisOFF,OFF, PleasePleaseturnturnON.ON.
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CQ CQ CQ THIS IS JA3YUA JA3YUA OSAKA JAPANCQ CQ CQ THIS IS JA3YUA JA3YUA OSAKA JAPAN
CQ CQ CQ THIS IS JA3YUA JA3YUA OSAKA JAPANCQ CQ CQ THIS IS JA3YUA JA3YUA OSAKA JAPAN
CQ CQ CQ THIS IS JA3YUA JA3YUA OSAKA JAPANCQ CQ CQ THIS IS JA3YUA JA3YUA OSAKA JAPAN
THRESHOLDTHRESHOLD 9
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1/41/4
OFFOFF
RTTYRTTY
FILFIL
ONON
<MENU1><MENU1>
HLD/CLRHLD/CLR TX MEMTX MEM
ADJADJ
WIDEWIDE
********RTTYRTTYDecodeDecodeMonitorMonitor ********
45bps45bpsBAUDOTBAUDOTMark=2125,Mark=2125,Shift=170Shift=170
UnShiftUnShiftOnOn SpaceSpacesupportsupport(SET-OTHERS)(SET-OTHERS)
NewNew LineLineCodeCodeselectableselectable(SET-OTHERS)(SET-OTHERS)
IfIfRTTY-FILRTTY-FILisisOFF,OFF, PleasePleaseturnturnON.ON.
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
THRESHOLDTHRESHOLD 9
RTTY DECODERTTY DECODE
DD
Setting the decoder threshold level
Adjust the RTTY decoder threshold level if some
characters are displayed when no signal is received.
q Call up the RTTY decoder screen as described
above.
w Push [(F-4)ADJ] to select the threshold level set-
ting condition.
e Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the RTTY decoder
threshold level.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select the default condi-
tion.
r Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the RTTY decoder
screen.
The UnShift On Space (USOS) function and new
line code can be set in the RTTY set mode. (p. 49)
THRESHOLD
THRESHOLD
9
9
ADJ
ADJ
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
1/4
1/4
OFF
OFF
RTTY
RTTY
FIL
FIL
ON
ON
DEF
DEF
ADJ
ADJ
WIDE
WIDE
****
****
RTTY
RTTY
Decode
Decode
Monitor
Monitor
****
****
45bps
45bps
BAUDOT
BAUDOT


Mark=2125,
Mark=2125,
Shift=170
Shift=170
UnShift
UnShift
On
On
Space
Space
support
support
(SET-OTHERS)
(SET-OTHERS)
New
New
Line
Line
Code
Code
selectable
selectable
(SET-OTHERS)
(SET-OTHERS)
If
If
RTTY-FIL
RTTY-FIL
is
is
OFF,
OFF,
Please
Please
turn
turn
ON.
ON.
--------------------------------------------
--------------------------------------------
RTTY DECODE
RTTY DECODE
47
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
RTTY memory transmission
Pre-set characters can be sent using the RTTY mem-
ory. Contents of the memory are set using the edit
menu.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select RTTY mode.
e Push [(F-3)DECODE] to turn the RTTY decoder
ON.
r Push [(F-3)TX MEM] to select RTTY memory
screen.
t Push [(F-5)1-4/5-8] to select memory bank then
push one of the function keys [(F-1)RT1] to [(F-4)
RT4] or [(F-1)RT5] to [(F-4)RT8].
The selected memory contents will be transmitted im-
mediately.
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
0FF0FF
RTTYRTTY
FILFIL
ONON
1/41/4
OFFOFF
BWBW
350350
SFTSFT
VFOVFO
FIL2FIL2
RTTYRTTY
qw:pp
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1
21. 085. 0021. 085. 00
21. 085. 0021. 085. 00
TXTX
VFOVFO
1
USBUSB
CWCW
CWCW
FIL2FIL2
RT1RT1
RT2RT2
RT3RT3
0
qr.qpp.pp
qr.qpp.pp
12:0012:00
RT4RT4
1-4/5-81-4/5-8
RTTY MEMORYRTTY MEMORY
RT1RT1
RT2RT2
RT3RT3
RT4RT4
DEDE ICOMICOM ICOMICOM K
QSLQSLURUR599-599599-599BKBK
QSLQSLDEDEICOMICOMICOMICOMURUR599-599599-599 BKBK
DEDE ICOMICOM ICOMICOM ICOM KICOM K
[(F-1)RT1]–[(F-4)RT4]
[(F-1)RT5]–[(F-4)RT8]
[EXIT/SET] [(F-5)1-4/5-8]
DD
RTTY tuning meter
The transceiver has an RTTY tuning indicator to be
tuned correctly and easily.
The RTTY tuning meter is automatically displayed
when the RTTY filter is turned ON.
q Push [CW/RTTY] to select RTTY mode.
w Push [RTTY FIL] to activate the RTTY filter and
RTTY tuning meter.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
RTTYRTTY
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
350 350
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
ANTANT
1
qw:pp
12:00
RTTY tuning meter
DD
Editing RTTY memory
48
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
4
The contents of the RTTY memories can be set using
the memory edit menu. The memory can memorize
and re-transmit 8 RTTY contents for often-used RTTY
sentences. Total capacity of the memory is 70 char-
acters per memory channel.
• Pre-programmed contents
•Programming contents
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select RTTY mode.
e Push [(F-3)DECODE] then [(F-1)MENU1] to select
the RTTY decode menu 2.
r Push [(F-2)EDIT] to enter the RTTY memory edit
screen.
t Push [(F-5)RT1..8] several times to select the de-
sired memory channel.
y Select the desired character group by pushing the
character group keys ([ABC], [123] or [etc]) sev-
eral times.
[etc] appears when [123] is pushed when “123” char-
acter group is selected.
Selectabel characters (with the tuning dial);
u Select the desired character by rotating the tuning
dial or by pushing the band key for number input.
Push [(F-1)
] or [(F-2)
] for cursor movement.
Push [(F-3)DEL] to delete the selected character.
Push [(F-4)SPACE] to input a space.
i Repeat step u until the desired contents are input.
o Push [(F-5)RT1..8] to select the next memory
channel and repeat step u for character input, if
desired.
!0 Push [EXIT/SET] to set the contents and exit
RTTY memory edit screen.
Key selection
ABCABC
Editable characters
A to Z (capital leters)
123123
0 to 9 (numbers)
! $ & ? " ' – / . , : ; ( )
etcetc
CH Contents
DE ICOM ICOM K
DE ICOM ICOM ICOM K
QSL UR 599–599 BK
RT1
RT2
RT3
QSL DE ICOM ICOM UR 599–599 BK
RT4
CQ CQ CQ DE ICOM ICOM ICOM K
RT6
RT7
RT8
73 GL SK
(blank)
(blank)
RT5
RTTY MEMORY EDITRTTY MEMORY EDIT
RT1RT1
RT2RT2
RT3RT3
RT4RT4
QSLQSLURUR599-599599-599BKBK
QSLQSLDEDEICOMICOMICOMICOMURUR599-599599-599 BKBK
DEDE ICOMICOM ICOMICOM ICOM KICOM K
ç
å
DELDEL
SPACESPACE RT1..8RT1..8
ABCABC
ABCABC
123123
DEDE ICOMICOM ICOMICOM K
Character
group
keys
Selected
character
Memory ch
select
[(F-2)][(F-1)]
[123]/[etc] [ABC]
[EXIT/SET] [(F-5)RT1..8]
[(F-3)DEL] [(F-4)SPACE]
49
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
RRTTTTYY DDeeccooddee UUSSOOSS
This item selects the USOS (UnShift On Space) func-
tion of the internal RTTY decoder.
OONN
Decode as letter code
(default)
OOFFFF
Decode as character code
RRTTTTYY TTXX UUSSOOSS
This item selects the FIGS insertion even changing
from LTRS to FIGS does not necessary when send-
ing a numeral or symbol character after a space.
OONN
Inserts FIGS
(default)
OOFFFF
Not insert FIGS
RRTTTTYY DDeeccooddee NNeeww LLiinnee CCooddee
This item selects the new line code of the internal
RTTY decoder.
CR : Carriage Return
LF : Line Feed
CCRR,,LLFF,,CCRR++LLFF
CR, LF and CR+LF
(default)
CCRR++LLFF
CR+LF only
DD
RTTY decoder set mode
This set mode is used to set the decode USOS func-
tion, etc.
Setting the contents
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times, if necessary.
w Push [CW/RTTY] to select RTTY mode.
e Push [(F-3)DECODE] then [(F-1)MENU1] to select
RTTY decode menu 2.
r Push [(F-4)SET] to select RTTY decode set mode.
t Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the desired set
item.
y Set the desired condition using the tuning dial.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default condition
or value.
u Push [EXIT/SET] to exit from set mode.
DEFDEF
RTTY DECODE SETRTTY DECODE SET
é
è
RTTYRTTYDecodeDecodeUSOSUSOS ONON
RTTYRTTYDecodeDecodeNewNewLineLine CodeCode CR,LF,CR+LFCR,LF,CR+LF
RTTYRTTYTXTX USOSUSOS ONON
AGCAGC
MIDMID
1/41/4
OFFOFF
RTTYRTTY
FILFIL
ONON
[(F-2)][(F-1)] [EXIT/SET]
[(F-3)DEL]
50
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
4
DD
Convenient functions for receive
Operating AM
q Push a band key to select the desired band.
w Push [AM/FM] to select AM.
“AM” indicator appears.
After AM mode is selected, push [AM/FM] to toggle be-
tween AM and FM modes.
e Rotate the tuning dial to tune a desired frequency.
The S-meter indicates received signal strength when
signal is received.
r Rotate [AF] to set audio to a comfortable listening
level.
t Push [TRANSMIT] or [PTT] (microphone) to trans-
mit.
The TX indicator lights red.
y Speak into the microphone at your normal voice
level.
Adjust the microphone gain with [MIC GAIN] at this step,
if necessary.
u Push [TRANSMIT] or release [PTT] (microphone)
to return to receive.
[TRANSMIT]
[AM/FM]
[AF] [MIC GAIN] Tuning dial
[TX] indicator [RX] indicator Band keys
Preamp (p. 57)
Push [P.AMP] several times to set the preamp
OFF, preamp 1 ON or preamp 2 ON.
•“P.AMP1” or “P.AMP2” appears when the preamp 1 or
preamp 2 is set to ON, respectively. (depending on
operating frequency band)
Attenuator (p. 57)
Push [ATT] several times to set the attenuator in
6 dB steps.
•“ATT” and attenuation level appear when the attenua-
tor is set to ON.
•Twin PBT (passband tuning) (p. 62)
Rotate [TWIN PBT] controls (inner/outer).
Push [PBT CLR] to clear the settings.
Noise reduction (p. 65)
Push [NR] switch to turn the noise reduction ON
and OFF.
Rotate [NR] control to adjust the noise reduction level.
Noise reduction indicator (in [NR] switch) lights when
the noise reduction is set to ON.
Noise blanker (p. 64)
Push [NB] switch to turn the noise blanker ON
and OFF.
Noise blanker indicator (in [NB] switch) lights when
the noise blanker is set to ON.
Push [NB] for 1 sec. to enter the noise blanker
level set mode, then rotate the tuning dial to ad-
just the threshold level.
Notch filter (p. 64)
Push [NOTCH] switch to turn the auto or manual
notch function ON and OFF.
Rotate [NOTCH] control to set the attenuating fre-
quency for manual notch operation.
Notch indicator (in [NOTCH] switch) lights when either
the auto or manual notch is set to ON.
AGC (auto gain control) (p. 59)
Push [AGC] switch several times to select
AGC FAST, AGC MID or AGC SLOW.
Push [AGC] for 1 sec. to enter the AGC set mode.
Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the time constant.
DD
Convenient functions for transmit
•Transmit quality monitor (p. 70)
Push [MONITOR] to turn the monitor function ON
and OFF.
Monitor indicator (in [MONITOR] switch) lights when
the monitor function is set to ON.
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select the monitor level item
with [(F-1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial
to adjust the monitor gain.
•VOX (voice operated transmit) (p. 66)
Push [VOX] to turn the VOX function ON and
OFF.
•“VOX ON” appears when the VOX function is set to
ON.
Audio tone control (p. 95)
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select an item with [(F-
1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial to adjust
the audio tone.
51
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
DD
Convenient functions for receive
Operating FM
q Push a band key to select the desired band.
w Push [AM/FM] to select FM.
“FM” indicator appears.
After FM mode is selected, push [AM/FM] to toggle be-
tween FM and AM modes.
e Rotate the tuning dial to tune a desired frequency.
The S-meter indicates received signal strength when
signal is received.
10 kHz tuning step is preset for FM mode.
r Rotate [AF] to set audio to a comfortable listening
level.
t Push [TRANSMIT] or [PTT] (microphone) to trans-
mit.
The TX indicator lights red.
y Speak into the microphone at your normal voice
level.
Adjust the microphone gain with [MIC GAIN] at this step,
if necessary.
u Push [TRANSMIT] or release [PTT] (microphone)
to return to receive.
[TRANSMIT]
[AM/FM][AF] [MIC GAIN] Tuning dial
[TX] indicator [RX] indicator Band keys
Preamp (p. 57)
Push [P.AMP] several times to set the preamp
OFF, preamp 1 ON or preamp 2 ON.
•“P.AMP1” or “P.AMP2” appears when the preamp 1 or
preamp 2 is set to ON, respectively. (depending on
operating frequency band)
Attenuator (p. 57)
Push [ATT] several times to set the attenuator in
6 dB steps.
•“ATT” and attenuation level appear when the attenua-
tor is set to ON.
Notch filter (p. 64)
Push [NOTCH] switch to turn the auto notch func-
tion ON and OFF.
Rotate [NOTCH] control to set the attenuating fre-
quency for manual notch operation.
Notch indicator (in [NOTCH] switch) lights when the
auto notch is set to ON.
DD
Convenient functions for transmit
•Transmit quality monitor (p. 70)
Push [MONITOR] to turn the monitor function ON
and OFF.
Monitor indicator (in [MONITOR] switch) lights when
the monitor function is set to ON.
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select the monitor level item
with [(F-1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial
to adjust the monitor gain.
VOX (voice operated transmit) (p. 66)
Push [VOX] to turn the VOX function ON and
OFF.
•“VOX ON” appears when the VOX function is set to
ON.
Audio tone control (p. 95)
Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode. Select an item with [(F-
1)
YY
]/[(F-2)
ZZ
] then rotate the tuning dial to adjust
the audio tone.
52
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
Repeater operation
A repeater amplifies received signals and retransmits
them at a different frequency. When using a repeater,
the transmit frequency is shifted from the receive fre-
quency by an offset frequency. A repeater can be ac-
cessed using split frequency operation with the shift
frequency set to the repeaters offset frequency.
For accessing a repeater which requires a repeater
tone, set the repeater tone frequency in set mode
as described below.
q Set the offset frequencies (HF, 50 MHz) and turn
ON the quick split function in set mode (others) in
advance. (p. 69)
w Push [VFO/MEMO] to select VFO mode.
e Push the desired band key.
r Push [AM/FM] several times to select FM mode.
t Set the receive frequency (repeater output fre-
quency).
y Push [SPLIT] for 1 sec. to start repeater operation.
Repeater tone is turned ON automatically.
Shifted transmit frequency and “TX” appear in the sub
readout.
The transmit frequency can be monitored while pushing
[XFC] or using dualwatch.
u Push and hold [PTT] to transmit; release [PTT] to
receive.
i To return to simplex, push [SPLIT] momentarily to
clear the sub display.
BWBW
15k15k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
FMFM
VFOVFO
FMFM
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wo.yip.pp
wo.tip.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
SPLITSPLIT
TXTX
TONETONE
TONETONE
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ATTATT
OFFOFF
P.AMPP.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
Tone encoder is auto-
matically turned ON.
Shifted frequency appears.
[AM/FM] [XFC]Tuning dial
[VFO/MEMO] [SPLIT] Band keys
DD
Setting the repeater tone
Some repeaters require subaudible tones to be ac-
cessed. Subaudible tones are superimposed over
your normal signal and must be set in advance. The
transceiver has 50 tones from 67.0 Hz to 254.1 Hz.
Each memory channel can store an independent set-
ting.
Store repeater tone frequencies and ON/OFF settings
in memory channels for easy recall.
q Select FM mode.
w Push [TONE] for 1 sec. to enter tone set mode.
e Push [(F-1)
YY
] to select “REPEATER TONE” item.
r Rotate the tuning dial to select the desired re-
peater tone frequency.
t Push [EXIT/SET] to exit tone set mode.
Available repeater tones (Unit: Hz)
T-SCANT-SCAN
é
è
DEFDEF
TONE FREQUENCYTONE FREQUENCY
88.5Hz88.5Hz
88.5Hz88.5HzT-SQL TONET-SQL TONE
REPEATER TONEREPEATER TONE
AGCAGC
FASTFAST
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
TONETONE
OFFOFF
CONVENIENT
[AM/FM][(F-1)Y] [EXIT/SET][TONE] Tuning dial
4
67.0
69.3
71.9
74.4
77.0
79.7
82.5
085.4
088.5
091.5
094.8
097.4
100.0
103.5
107.2
110.9
114.8
118.8
123.0
127.3
131.8
136.5
141.3
146.2
151.4
156.7
159.8
162.2
165.5
167.9
171.3
173.8
177.3
179.9
183.5
186.2
189.9
192.8
196.6
199.5
203.5
206.5
210.7
218.1
225.7
229.1
233.6
241.8
250.3
254.1
53
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
Tone squelch operation
The tone squelch opens only when receiving a signal
containing a matching subaudible tone. You can
silently wait for calls from group members using the
same tone.
Available tone squelch tones (Unit: Hz)
q Set the desired frequency band and select FM
mode.
w Push [TONE] several times until “TSQL” appears.
e Push [TONE] for 1 sec. to enter tone set mode.
r Push [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the “T-SQL TONE” item.
t Rotate the tuning dial to select the desired tone
squelch frequency.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select the default setting.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to return to the previous indica-
tion.
u When the received signal includes a matching tone,
squelch opens and the signal can be heard.
When the received signal’s tone does not match, tone
squelch does not open, however, the S-indicator shows
signal strength.
•To open the squelch manually, push [XFC].
i Operate the transceiver in the normal way.
o To cancel the tone squelch, push [TONE] to clear
“TSQL.”
Store tone squelch frequencies and ON/OFF settings
in memory channels for easy recall.
CONVENIENT
T-SCANT-SCAN
é
è
DEFDEF
TONE FREQUENCYTONE FREQUENCY
88.5Hz88.5Hz
88.5Hz88.5HzT-SQL TONET-SQL TONE
REPEATER TONEREPEATER TONE
AGCAGC
FASTFAST
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
TONETONE
OFFOFF
BWBW
15k15k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
FMFM
VFOVFO
FMFM
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wo.yip.pp
wo.tip.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
TSQLTSQL
TSQLTSQL
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ATTATT
OFFOFF
P.AMPP.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
[AM/FM] [XFC]Tuning dial
[VFO/MEMO] [SPLIT] Band keys
67.0
69.3
71.9
74.4
77.0
79.7
82.5
085.4
088.5
091.5
094.8
097.4
100.0
103.5
107.2
110.9
114.8
118.8
123.0
127.3
131.8
136.5
141.3
146.2
151.4
156.7
159.8
162.2
165.5
167.9
171.3
173.8
177.3
179.9
183.5
186.2
189.9
192.8
196.6
199.5
203.5
206.5
210.7
218.1
225.7
229.1
233.6
241.8
250.3
254.1
54
4
RECEIVE AND TRANSMIT
Data mode (SSTV/PSK31) operation
4
For your information
Carrier point frequency is displayed when SSB data
mode is selected.
See the diagram below for the tone-pair example.
When operating SSTV or PSK31 with your PC soft-
ware, consult the manual that comes with the software.
q Connect a PC to the transceiver. (p. 19)
w Push a band key to select the desired band.
e Push [SSB] or [AM/FM] to select the desired oper-
ating mode.
r Push the same key for 1 sec. to turn data mode ON.
“-D” indicator additionally appears.
t Rotate the tuning dial to tune into the desired signal
and decoded correctly.
Also use the tuning indicator of the software.
• During SSB data mode,
1
4 tuning function can be used
for critical tuning.
y Operate the PC (software) to transmit.
When operating in SSB data mode, adjust the AF output
level from PC so that the ALC meter reading doesn’t go
outside the ALC zone.
NOTE: When SSB data mode is selected, the audio
input from the [ACC(1)] (pin 6) is used for transmis-
sion instead of [MIC]’s.
The fixed condition is used for SSB data transmis-
sion as follow.
[COMP] : OFF
Tx bandwidth : MID
Tx Tone (Bass) : 0
Tx Tone (Trebles) : 0
200 Hz 2125 Hz
2325 Hz
Carrier point
(displayed frequency)
[TRANSMIT]
[AM/FM][AF] [MIC GAIN] Tuning dial
[TX] indicator [RX] indicator Band keys
DMini scope screen
Spectrum scope screen
This function allows you to display the relative
strengths of signals around the center frequency. The
span can be set to ±12.5 kHz, ±25 kHz, ±50 kHz and
±100 kHz. Ideal for monitoring band conditions in an
instant.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-1)SCOPE] to select the scope screen.
e Push [(F-1)SPAN] several times to select the scope
span.
r Push [(F-2)ATT] several times to activate an atten-
uator or turn the attenuator OFF.
10, 20 and 30 dB attenuators are available.
t Push [(F-3)MARKER] several times to select the
marker (sub readout or transmit frequency) or turn
the marker OFF.
•“TX MARKER” displays the marker at the transmit fre-
quency.
•“SUB MARKER” displays the marker at the sub readout
frequency.
y Push [(F-4)HOLD] to freeze the current spectrum
waveform.
“HOLD” appears while the function is in use.
u Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the scope screen.
If a strong signal is received, a ghost waveform may
appear. Push [(F-2)ATT] several times to activate
the spectrum scope attenuator in this case.
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpq.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
1
VFO
VFO
SUB
SUB
MARKER
MARKER
ATT
ATT
10dB
10dB
HOLD
HOLD
Grid
Grid
2.5k
2.5k
10dB
10dB
+12.5k
+12.5k
-12.5k
-12.5k
SPECTRUM SCOPE
SPECTRUM SCOPE
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
HOLD
HOLD
SET
SET
SPAN
SPAN
ATT
ATT
MARKER
MARKER
qw:pp
12:00
Appears when the
marker is out of range.
Sub readout
or TX marker
Appears when the
marker is out of range.
[(F-3)MARKER]
[(F-2)ATT][(F-1)SPAN] [EXIT/SET]
[(F-4)HOLD]
[(F-5)SET]
5
55
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
This mini scope screen can be displayed with another
screen indication, such as set mode menu, decoder
screen, memory list screen, etc. simultaneously.
Push [MAIN/SUB•M.SCOPE] for 1 sec. to toggle
the mini scope indication ON and OFF.
**** RTTY Encode/Decode Monitor **** **** RTTY Encode/Decode Monitor ****
45bps BAUDOT Mark=2125Hz, Shift=170Hz 45bps BAUDOT Mark=2125Hz, Shift=170Hz
Max.62 Charascters x 8ch TX Memory Max.62 Charascters x 8ch TX Memory
If RTTY-FIL is OFF, Please turn ON. If RTTY-FIL is OFF, Please turn ON.
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
RTTYRTTY
FILFIL
ONON
1/41/4
OFFOFF
RTTY DECODERTTY DECODE
BWBW
350350
SFTSFT
0
VFOVFO
VFOVFO
wq≥qpp≥pp
14.100.0014.100.00
RTTY RTTY FIL2FIL2
SSBSSB
FIL2FIL2
TXTX
THRESHOLDTHRESHOLD 9 9
<MENU1><MENU1>
HLD/CLRHLD/CLR
TX MEMTX MEM
ADJADJ
WIDEWIDE
qw:pp
12:00
Grid
2.5k
10dB
+ 12.5k
- 12.5k
SPECTRUM SCOPE
[MAIN/SUB•M.SCOPE]
56
4
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
5
DScope set mode
The spectrum scope shows the transmit signal wave-
form while transmitting. This can be deactivated if de-
sired.
The spectrum scope shows the transmit signal wave-
form while transmitting. This can be deactivated if de-
sired.
When “OFF” is selected, the spectrum scope holds
the received waveform while transmitting and does
not show the transmit waveform.
q During spectrum scope indication ON, push [(F-5)
SET] to select scope set mode screen.
w Push [(F-5)SET] to select the spectrum scope set
mode.
e Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the desired set
item.
r Rotate the tuning dial to select the desired condi-
tion.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default condition.
t Push [EXIT/SET] to exit spectrum scope set
mode.
DEFDEF
é
è
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ScopeScope duringduringTxTx ONON
MaxMax HoldHold ONON
SCOPESCOPE SETSET
[(F-2)Z][(F-1)Y] [EXIT/SET] [(F-3)DEF]
SSccooppee dduurriinngg TTxx
Turn the transmitting signal waveform indication ON
and OFF.
When “OFF” is selected, the spectrum scope holds
the received waveform while transmitting and does
not show the transmit waveform. (default: ON)
MMaaxx HHoolldd
Turn the peak level holding function ON and OFF.
(default: ON)
57
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
Preamplifier
The preamp amplifies received signals in the front
end circuit to improve the S/N ratio and increase the
sensitivity. Set this to preamp 1 or preamp 2 when re-
ceiving weak signals.
Push [P.AMP] several times to set the preamp
OFF, preamp 1 ON or preamp 2 ON.
•“P. AMP1” activates 10 dB preamp for HF all bands.
•“P. AMP2” activates 16 dB high-gain preamp for
24 MHz band and above.
Regarding the use of the “P.AMP 2”
(Pre-amplifier 2)
The “P.AMP 2” is a high gain receive amplifier. When
the “P.AMP 2” is used during times of strong electric
fields, distortion sometimes results. In such cases,
use the transceiver with the “P.AMP 1” or “P.AMP
OFF” setting.
The “P.AMP 2” is most effective when:
Used on bands above 24 MHz and when electric
fields are weak.
Receive sensitivity is insufficient during low gain, or
while using a narrow band antenna (such as small
loop, a Beverage antenna or a short Yagi antenna,
etc.) is used.
[P.AMP]
Attenuator
The attenuator prevents a desired signal from distor-
tion when very strong signals are near the desired fre-
quency or when very strong electric fields, such as
from broardcasting stations, are near your location.
Push [ATT] several times to set the attenuator 6
dB, 12 dB, 18 dB or OFF.
•“ATT 6dB,” “ATT 12dB,” “ATT 18dB” and “ATT OFF” ap-
pears respectively.
[ATT]
58
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
5
RIT function
The RIT (Receive Increment Tuning) function com-
pensates for off-frequencies of the communicating
station.
The function shifts the receive frequency up to ±9.999
kHz in 1 Hz steps (10 Hz steps when cancelling the 1
Hz step readout) without moving the transmit fre-
quency.
See #1 on p. 5 for function description.
q Push [RIT] to turn the RIT function ON and OFF.
•“ ” and the shifting frequency appear when the
function is ON.
w Rotate the [RIT/
TX] control.
e To reset the RIT frequency, push [CLEAR] for
1 sec.
Push [CLEAR] momentarily to reset the RIT frequency
when the quick RIT/TX clear function is ON. (p. 103)
r To cancel the RIT function, push [RIT] again.
•“ ” disappears.
RIT
RIT
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
USB
USB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
p.pp
RIT
1
VFO
VFO
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
Reset to
“0.00”
RIT/TX
Low shift High shift
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
USB
USB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
q.wt
RIT
1
VFO
VFO
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
Appear
RIT
RIT
[CLEAR]
[RIT/TX][RIT]
When RIT and TX are ON at the same time, the
[RIT/
TX] control shifts both the transmit and re-
ceive frequencies from the displayed frequency at
the same time.
•Calculate function
The shift frequency of the RIT (or TX) function can
be added/subtracted to the displayed frequency.
While displaying the RIT (and/or TX) shift fre-
quency, push [RIT] (or [
TX]) for 1 sec.
Practical example
When you find a DX station on 21.025 MHz/CW and
the station is picking up stations transmitting slightly
up from 21.025 MHz.
q Push [RIT] and [
TX] to turn both the RIT and
TX functions ON.
w Rotate [RIT/
TX] to find the DX station’s receive
frequency.
e When you find the DX station’s receive frequency,
push [RIT] to turn the RIT function OFF.
Now you can transmit the DX station’s receive fre-
quency and receive the DX station’s transmit fre-
quency (21.025 MHz).
r Start transmitting while the station is standing by.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
p.wt
RIT
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.wt
14.100.0014.100.00
p.pp
RIT
1
VFOVFO
1
VFOVFO
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
Push and hold
RIT
59
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
AGC function
The AGC (auto gain control) controls receiver gain to
produce a constant audio output level even when the
received signal strength is varied by fading, etc.
The transceiver has 3 AGC characteristics (time con-
stant; fast, mid, slow) for non-FM mode.
The FM mode AGC time constant is fixed as ‘FAST’
(0.1 sec.) and AGC time constant cannot be se-
lected.
[AGC]
[EXIT/SET][(F-3)DEF]
AGC time constant selection
q Select non-FM mode.
w Push [AGC] several times to select AGC fast, AGC
medium (MID) or AGC slow.
Selectable AGC time constant (unit: sec.)
Setting the AGC time constant
q Select the desired mode other than FM mode.
w Push [AGC] for 1 sec. to enter AGC set mode.
e Push [AGC] several times to select FAST time
constant.
r Rotate the tuning dial to set the desired time con-
stant for ‘AGC FAST.’
AGC time constant can be set between 0.1 to 8.0 sec.
(depends on mode) or turned OFF.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default value.
t Push [AGC] to select medium time constant.
y Rotate the tuning dial to set the desired time con-
stant for ‘AGC MID.’
AGC time constant can be set between 0.1 to 8.0 sec.
(depends on mode) or turned OFF.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default value.
u Push [AGC] to select slow time constant.
i Rotate the tuning dial to set the desired time con-
stant for ‘AGC SLOW.’
AGC time constant can be set between 0.1 to 8.0 sec.
(depends on mode) or turned OFF.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default value.
o Select another mode other than FM. Repeat steps
e to i if desired.
!0 Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the AGC set mode
screen.
DEFDEF
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
AGCAGC
(sec)(sec)
FMFM
AMAM
0.10.1
3.03.0
5.05.0
7.07.0
1.21.2
0.50.5
0.10.1
0.10.1
0.30.3
2.02.0
6.06.0
0.50.5
1.21.2
------
------
SSBSSB
FASTFAST
SLOWSLOW
MIDMID
CWCW RTTYRTTY
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
Medium AGC time constant
Slow AGC time constant
Fast AGC time constant
AGC
MID
AGC
SLOW
AGC
FAST
Mode Default Selectable AGC time constant
0.3 (FAST)
OFF, 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.5, 0.8, 1.2,
SSB 2.0 (MID)
1.6, 2.0, 2.5, 3.0, 4.0, 5.0, 6.0
6.0 (SLOW)
0.1 (FAST)
OFF, 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.5, 0.8, 1.2,
CW 0.5 (MID)
1.6, 2.0, 2.5, 3.0, 4.0, 5.0, 6.0
1.2 (SLOW)
0.1 (FAST)
OFF, 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.5, 0.8, 1.2,
RTTY 0.5 (MID)
1.6, 2.0, 2.5, 3.0, 4.0, 5.0, 6.0
1.2 (SLOW)
3.0 (FAST)
OFF, 0.3, 0.5, 0.8, 1.2, 1.6, 2.0,
AM 5.0 (MID)
2.5, 3.0, 4.0, 5.0, 6.0, 7.0, 8.0
7.0 (SLOW)
FM 0.1 (FAST) Fixed
60
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
5
Twin PBT operation
General PBT (Passband Tuning) function electronically
narrows the IF passband width by shifting the IF fre-
quency to slightly outside of the IF filter passband to
reject interference. This transceiver uses the DSP cir-
cuit for the PBT function. Moving both [TWIN PBT]
controls to the same position shifts the IF.
The LCD shows the passband width and shift fre-
quency graphically.
Push [FILTER] for 1 sec. to enter the filter set
mode. Current passband width and shift frequency
is displayed in the filter set mode screen.
To set the [TWIN PBT] controls to the center posi-
tions, push [PBT CLR] for 1 sec.
The variable range depends on the passband width
and mode. The edge of the variable range is half of the
passband width, and PBT is adjustable in 25 or 50 Hz
steps. These controls function as an IF shift control
while in AM mode and when the RTTY filter is turned
ON. Only the inner control may function in this case.
IF shift is adjustable in 20/40 Hz steps in RTTY (RTTY
filter is turned ON) or 150/300/500 Hz steps in AM.
[TWIN PBT] should normally be set to the center posi-
tions (PBT setting is cleared) when there is no interfer-
ence.
When PBT is used, the audio tone may be changed.
Not available for FM mode.
•While rotating [TWIN PBT], noise may occur. This comes
from the DSP unit and does not indicate an equipment
malfunction.
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
1
VFO
VFO
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
qw:pp
12:00
Shows filter width, shifting value and condition
[TWIN PBT]
[PBT CLR][FILTER]
PBT OPERATION EXAMPLE
61
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
IF filter selection
The transceiver has 3 passband width IF filters for
each mode.
For SSB and CW modes, the passband width can be
set within 50 to 3600 Hz in 50 or 100 Hz steps. A total
of 41 passband widths are available.
For RTTY mode, the passband width can be set within
50 to 2700 Hz in 50 or 100 Hz steps. A total of 32
passband widths are available.
For AM and FM modes, the passband width is fixed
and 3 passband widths are available.
The filter selection is automatically memorized in
each mode.
The PBT shift frequencies are automatically memo-
rized in each filter.
[FILTER]
IF filter selection
q Select the desired mode.
w For RTTY mode, turn OFF the RTTY filter by push-
ing [RTTY FIL].
e Push [FILTER] several times to select the IF filter
1, 2 or 3.
The selected passband width and filter number is dis-
played in the LCD.
Filter passband width setting
(SSB, CW and RTTY mode only)
q Select SSB, CW or RTTY mode.
Passband widths for AM and FM modes are fixed and
cannot be set.
w For RTTY mode, turn OFF the RTTY filter by push-
ing [RTTY FIL].
e Push [FILTER] for 1 sec. to enter filter set mode.
r Push [FILTER] several times to select the desired
IF filter.
t While pushing [(F-1)BW], rotate the tuning dial to
set the desired passband width.
The passband width can be set within the range as
shown right table.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select the default value.
y Repeat steps r to t if desired.
u Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the filter set mode screen.
The PBT shift frequencies are cleared when the
passband width is changed.
This filter set mode screen graphically displays the
PBT shift frequencies and CW pitch operations.
*: When the IF filter is selected FIL2 or FIL3 in the FM
mode operation, the Tx IF filter’s passband width is
fixed narrow selection (2.5 kHz).
FIL1
Mode Filter Default Range (Steps)
3.0 kHz
1.8 kHz
2.4 kHz
1.2 kHz
250 Hz
7.0 kHz
500 Hz
2.4 kHz
250 Hz
500 Hz
9.0 kHz
3.0 kHz
6.0 kHz
10 kHz
Fixed
Fixed
15 kHz
50–500 Hz (50 Hz)/
600–3.6 kHz (100 Hz)
50–500 Hz (50 Hz)/
600–3.6 kHz (100 Hz)
50–500 Hz (50 Hz)/
600–2.7 kHz (100 Hz)
FIL2
SSB
RTTY
AM
FM*
SSB-D
CW
FIL3
FIL1
FIL2
FIL3
FIL1
FIL2
FIL3
FIL1
FIL2
FIL3
FIL1
FIL2
FIL3
BWBW
DEFDEF
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
FILTERFILTER
SSBSSB
FIFIL 1
FIFIL 2
FIFIL 3
3.0k3.0k
2.4K2.4K
1.8K1.8K
PBT2PBT2
PBT1PBT1
300300 15001500 27002700
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
Passband
width
Selected
IF filter
62
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
DSP filter shape
The type of DSP filter shape for each SSB and CW
can be selected independently from soft and sharp.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [EXIT/SET] switch for 1 sec. to enter set
mode.
e Push [(F-3)DSP] to enter the DSP filter set mode.
r Push one of [(F-2)SSB-FIL] or [(F-4)CW-FIL] to
select the desired DSP filter shape from sharp and
soft for each SSB or CW mode, respectively.
t Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the set mode.
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
DSP FILTER SET
SSBSSB
SHARPSHARP CWCW
SHARPSHARP
SSB-FILSSB-FIL CW-FILCW-FIL
SSBSSB
SOFTSOFT CWCW SOFTSOFT
F-4
Push
F-2
Push
[EXIT/SET][(F-3)DSP][(F-2)SSB-FIL] [(F-4)CW-FIL]
5
63
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
Dualwatch operation
Dualwatch monitors 2 frequencies with the same mode
simultaneously.
During dualwatch, both frequencies should be on the
same band, because the bandpass filter in the RF cir-
cuit is selected for the main readout frequency.
RIT function can be used for the main readout only.
TX function can be used for the transmit readout
(main readout when the split function is OFF; sub
readout when the split function is ON).
q Set a desired frequency.
w Push [DUALWATCH] for 1 sec.
Equalized receive frequency and “ ” appear in
the LCD. This quick dualwatch function can be turned
OFF in set mode. (p. 100)
Pushing [DUALWATCH] momentarily activates the du-
alwatch with the previously operated frequency.
e Set another desired frequency using the tuning dial.
r Adjust [BAL] to set a suitable signal strength bal-
ance between the main and sub readout frequen-
cies.
S-meter shows the combined signal strength.
t To transmit on the sub readout frequency, push
[CHANGE] or [SPLIT].
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
TXTX
5656
1
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
DUAL-WDUAL-W
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
DUAL-W
DUAL-W
[BAL] [CHANGE][DUALWATCH] [SPLIT]
Scanning during dualwatch
Scanning operates only for the main readout. To op-
erate the scan during dualwatch, scan on the main
readout and use the sub readout for your QSO using
both dualwatch and split frequency operation.
q Program the desired programmed scan edges in
the same amateur band. See p. 79 for program-
ming.
If you plan to operate a F scan, programming the
scan edges may not be necessary.
w Push [SPLIT] to turn the split frequency function
ON.
•“ ” appears.
e Select VFO mode for the main readout.
r Set the desired operating frequency for the main
readout.
t Push [DUALWATCH] for 1 sec.
•The main and sub readout frequencies are equalized
and the dualwatch function is turned ON.
y Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-func-
tion screen, if necessary.
u Push [(F-1)PROG] or [(F-2)
F] to start the pro-
grammed scan or F scan, respectively.
Scan activates on the main readout between the pro-
grammed scan edges or within the F span.
•Transmitting on the sub readout stops the scan.
i To cancel the scan, push [EXIT/SET].
wq.wop.pp
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wtp.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
SPLITSPLIT
1
1
DUAL-WDUAL-W
PROGPROG
F
FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
SCANSCAN
TXTX
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
PROGRAM SCANPROGRAM SCAN
F SpanSpan: ±±10kHz10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1: 21.000.00MHz21.000.00MHz
scanscan edgesedges P2:P2: 21.450.00MHz21.450.00MHz
wq.wop.pp
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
SPLITSPLIT
1
1
DUAL-WDUAL-W
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
qw:pp
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
qr.wpt.pp
SPLITSPLIT
1
1
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
SPLIT
SPLIT
64
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
Notch function
This transceiver has auto and manual notch func-
tions. The auto notch function automatically attenu-
ates more than 3 beat tones, tuning signals, etc.,
even if they are moving. The manual notch can be set
to attenuate a frequency via the [NOTCH] control.
The auto notch can be used in SSB, AM and FM
modes.
The manual notch can be used in SSB, CW, RTTY,
and AM modes.
Push [NOTCH] to toggle the notch function be-
tween auto, manual and OFF in SSB and AM
modes.
Push [NOTCH] to turn the manual notch function
ON and OFF in CW and RTTY modes.
Push [NOTCH] to turn the auto notch function ON
and OFF in FM mode.
Set to attenuate a frequency for manual notch via the
[NOTCH] control.
“AN” appears when auto notch is in use.
“MN” appears when manual notch is in use.
While operating the manual notch, noise may be
heard. This comes from the DSP unit and does not
indicate an equipment malfunction.
Unwanted tone
frequency
Desired
signal (AF)
Desired
signal (AF)
Particular frequency
is attenuated
Auto notch OFF Auto notch ON
[NOTCH](control)[NOTCH](switch)
Noise blanker
The noise blanker eliminates pulse-type noise such
as from car ignitions. The noise blanker is not avail-
able for FM mode.
q Push [NB] to turn the noise blanker ON.
[NB] indicator lights.
w Push [NB] for 1 sec. to enter the noise blanker
level set mode.
e Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the noise blanker
level.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to return to default value.
r Push [NB] to turn the noise blanker OFF.
[NB] indicator goes off.
When using the noise blanker, received signals
may be distorted if they are excessively strong.
VOX
VOX
ON
ON
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
NB
NB
NB Level
NB Level
50%
50%
DEF
DEF
[NB] Tuning dial[(F-3)DEF]
5
65
5
FUNCTION FOR RECEIVE
Dial lock function
The dial lock function prevents changes by accidental
movement of the tuning dial. The lock function elec-
tronically locks the dial.
Push [LOCK/SPEECH] to toggle the dial lock func-
tion ON and OFF.
The [LOCK] indicator lights when the dial lock function
is in use.
[LOCK] indicator
[LOCK/SPEECH] switch
Noise reduction
The noise reduction function reduces noise compo-
nents and picks out desired signals which are buried
in noise. The received signals are converted to digital
signals and then the desired signals are separated
from the noise.
q Push the [NR] switch to turn the noise reduction
ON.
[NR] indicator lights.
w Rotate the [NR] control to adjust the noise reduc-
tion level.
e Push the [NR] switch to turn the noise reduction
OFF.
[NR] indicator lights off.
Deep rotation of the [NR] control results in audio
signal masking or distortion. Set the [NR] control
for maximum readability.
Noise reduction OFF Noise reduction activated
Desired
signal (CW)
Noise components
BAL NR
OFF
BAL NR
[NR](control) [NR](switch)
DAdjusting the VOX function
DUsing the VOX function
6
66
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
VOX function
q Select a phone mode (SSB, AM, FM).
w Push [VOX] to turn the VOX function ON or OFF.
“VOX ON” appears while the VOX is in use.
[VOX]
q Select a phone mode (SSB, AM, FM).
w Push [VOX] to turn VOX function ON.
e Push [VOX] for 1 sec. to enter VOX set mode.
r Select the VOX gain item using [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-
2)
ZZ
].
t While speaking into the microphone, rotate the
tuning dial to the point where the transceiver is
continuously transmitting.
y Adjust the VOX delay for a convenient interval be-
fore returning to receive.
-Select the VOX delay item using [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
].
-Rotate the tuning dial.
u If the receive audio from the speaker switches to
transmit, adjust the anti VOX to the point where it
has no effect.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
é
è
DEF
VOX
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
VOXGain 50%
Anti-VOX 50%
VOXDelay 0.2s
[VOX]
The VOX (Voice-Operated Transmission) function
switches between transmit and receive with your voice.
This function provides an opportunity to input log en-
tries into your computer, etc., while operating.
5
6
DFull break-in operation
DSemi break-in operation
Break-in function
During semi break-in operation, the transceiver se-
lects transmit when keying, then automatically returns
to receive after a pre-set time from when you stop
keying.
q Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW or CW-R mode.
w Push [BK-IN] several times to turn the semi break-
in function ON.
“BK-IN SEMI” appears.
e Rotate [BK-IN DELAY] to set the break-in delay
time (the delay from transmit to receive).
When using a paddle, rotate [KEY SPEED] to ad-
just the keying speed.
[BK-IN]
[BK-IN DELAY] [KEY SPEED]
During full break-in operation, the transceiver auto-
matically selects transmit while keying and returns to
receive immediately after keying is finished.
q Push [CW/RTTY] to select CW or CW-R mode.
w Push [BK-IN] several times to turn the full break-in
function ON.
“BK-IN FULL” appears.
When using a paddle, rotate [KEY SPEED] to ad-
just the keying speed.
[BK-IN]
[KEY SPEED]
The break-in function is used in CW mode to automat-
ically toggle the transceiver between transmit and re-
ceive when keying. The IC-756PROIII is capable for
full break-in or semi break-in.
67
6
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
68
6
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
6
Transmit filter width setting (SSB only)
The transmit filter width for SSB mode can be se-
lected from wide, middle and narrow.
During USB or LSB mode selection, push [COMP]
for 1 sec. several times to select the desired trans-
mit filter width from wide, middle and narrow.
The filter functions regardless of the speech compres-
sor use.
The following filters are specified as the default. Each
of the filter width can be re-set in level set mode.
(pgs. 95, 96)
WIDE : 100 Hz to 2.9 kHz
MID : 300 Hz to 2.7 kHz
NAR : 500 Hz to 2.5 kHz
[COMP]
Speech compressor
The speech compressor increases average RF out-
put power, improving signal strength and readability
in SSB mode.
Speech compressor
q Select USB or LSB mode.
w Push [COMP] momentarily to turn the speech
compressor ON and OFF.
e Push [COMP] for 1 sec. to select between narrow,
middle or wide transmit filter.
•Transmit filter width: (see above for details)
NAR 2.0 kHz
MID 2.4 kHz
WIDE 2.8 kHz
Compression level setting
q Select USB or LSB mode.
w Preset the transceiver as follows:
‘COMP’ function : OFF
‘METER’ function : ALC
[MIC GAIN] control : Center position
[COMP] control : Center position
[RF POWER] control : Max. counterclockwise
e Transmit at your normal voice level.
r Adjust the [MIC GAIN] control so that the ALC
meter reads within the ALC zone, whether or not
you speak softly or loudly.
t Push [COMP] momentarily to turn the speech
compressor ON.
y Push [METER] once to select the COMP meter.
u Adjust the [COMP] control so that the COMP
meter reads within 10 dB and 20 dB.
When the ALC meter peaks above the ALC zone,
your transmitted voice may be distorted.
[COMP] (switch)[METER]
[RF POWER] [COMP] (control)
[MIC GAIN]
SWR
S
COMP
ALC
Po
0
10
10
25 50
100
20
1
0
1. 5
2
3
1
5
9
+20
+40
+60dB
dB
COMP meter
69
6
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
TX function
The TX function shifts the transmit frequency up to
±9.999 kHz in 1 Hz steps (10 Hz steps when can-
celling the 1 Hz step readout) without moving the re-
ceive frequency.
See @9 on p. 5 for function description.
q Push [
TX] switch.
•“ ” and the shifting frequency appear when the
function is ON.
w Rotate the [RIT/
TX] control.
e To reset the TX frequency, push [CLEAR] for
1 sec.
Push [CLEAR] momentarily to reset the RIT frequency
when the quick RIT/TX clear function is ON. (p. 103)
r To cancel the TX function, push [
TX] again.
•“ ” and the shifting frequency disappears.
TX
TX
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
USB
USB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
p.pp
:
TX
1
VFO
VFO
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
Reset to
“0.00”
RIT/TX
Low shift High shift
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
USB
USB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
q.wt
:
TX
TX
1
VFO
VFO
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
qw:pp
12:00
Appear
TX
TX
[CLEAR]
[RIT/TX][TX]
When RIT and TX are ON at the same time, the
[RIT/
TX] control shifts both the transmit and re-
ceive frequencies from the displayed frequency at
the same time.
•Calculate function
The shift frequency of the (RIT or) TX function can
be added/subtracted to the displayed frequency.
While displaying the (RIT and/or) TX shift fre-
quency, push ([RIT] or) [
TX] for 1 sec.
Practical example
When you find a DX station on 21.025 MHz/CW and
the station is picking up stations transmitting slightly
up from 21.025 MHz.
q Push [RIT] and [
TX] to turn both the RIT and
TX functions ON.
w Rotate [RIT/
TX] to find the DX station’s receive
frequency.
e When you find the DX station’s receive frequency,
push [RIT] to turn the RIT function OFF.
Now you can transmit the DX station’s receive fre-
quency and receive the DX station’s transmit fre-
quency (21.025 MHz).
r Start transmitting while the station is standing by.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
p.wt
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.wt
14.100.0014.100.00
p.pp
1
VFOVFO
1
VFOVFO
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
:
TX
:
TX
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
Push and hold
TX
70
6
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
6
Monitor function
The monitor function allows you to monitor your trans-
mit IF signals in any mode through the speaker. Use
this to check voice characteristics while adjusting
SSB transmit tones. (p. 95) The CW side tone func-
tions regardless of the [MONITOR] switch setting.
q Push [MONITOR].
The indicator (in [MONITOR] switch) lights when the
monitor function is ON.
w Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
e Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-1)LEVEL] to
enter level set mode.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the monitor
level item.
t Adjust monitor gain using the tuning dial.
Pushing [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. sets the selected item to
the default value.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit level set mode.
Use headphones to prevent feedback.
Set the transmit tone settings to the 0 dB positions
to check the unaltered characteristics of transmit-
ter or microphone.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
é
è
DEF
LEVEL SET
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
SSBTBW(NAR) L 500
SSBTBW(NAR) H 2500
MonitorLevel 50%
SideToneLevel 50%
SideToneLevelLimit ON
BeepLevel 50%
BeepLevelLimit ON
[MONITOR]
[PHONES] jack
71
6
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
Split frequency operation
q Set 21.290 MHz (USB) in VFO mode.
w Push [SPLIT] momentarily, then push [CHANGE]
for 1 sec.
The quick split function is much more convenient for
selecting the transmit frequency. See the next page for
details.
The equalized transmit frequency and “ ” appear
on the LCD.
“TX” appears to show the transmit frequency’s readout.
e Rotate the tuning dial while pushing [XFC] to set
the transmit frequency to 21.310 MHz.
The transmit frequency can be monitored while pushing
[XFC] or using dualwatch.
r Now you can receive on 21.290 MHz and transmit
on 21.310 MHz.
To change the transmit and receive frequencies, push
[CHANGE] to exchange the main and sub readouts.
DIRECT SHIFT FREQUENCY INPUT
The shift frequency can be entered directly.
q Push [(F-INP)ENT].
w Enter the desired shift frequency with the digit
keys.
•1 kHz to 1 MHz can be set.
When you require a minus shift direction, push [•] in
advance.
e Push [SPLIT].
The shift frequency is input in the sub readout and the
split function is turned ON.
[EXAMPLE]
DUALWATCH FUNCTION
The dualwatch function is convenient for tuning the
transmit frequency while monitoring both frequencies
used for transmitting and receiving.
SPLIT LOCK FUNCTION
Accidentally releasing the [XFC] switch while rotating
the tuning dial changes the receive frequency. To pre-
vent this, use both the split lock and dial lock func-
tions to change the transmit frequency only. The split
lock function cancels the dial lock function while push-
ing [XFC] during split frequency operation.
The dial lock’s effectiveness during split frequency op-
eration can be selected in the set mode for both re-
ceive and transmit frequencies; or only the receive
frequency. (p. 100)
CONVENIENT
CONVENIENT
1 SPLIT
3 SPLIT
F-INP
ENT
F-INP
ENT
To operate on 1 kHz
higher frequency:
To operate on 3 kHz
lower frequency:
CONVENIENT
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
wq.eqp.pp
1
1
SPLITSPLIT
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
wq.wop.pp
1
1
SPLITSPLIT
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
SPLIT
SPLIT
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
VFO
VFO
qr.wpt.pp
1
1
ANT
ANT
1
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
qw:pp
12:00
Split frequency operation allows you to transmit and
receive in the same mode on two different frequencies.
The split frequency operation is basically performed
using 2 frequencies on the main and sub readouts.
The following is an example of setting 21.290 MHz for
receiving and 21.310 MHz for transmitting.
[XFC][CHANGE]
[(F-INP)ENT][SPLIT]
72
6
FUNCTION FOR TRANSMIT
Quick split function
q Suppose you are operating at 21.290 MHz (USB)
in VFO mode.
w Push [SPLIT] for 1 sec.
Split frequency operation is turned ON.
The sub readout is equalized to the main readout fre-
quency.
The sub readout enters standby for transmit frequency
input.
e Rotate the tuning dial to set the transmit fre-
quency; or, input the transmit frequency using the
keypad and [(F-INP)ENT]; or, input a shift fre-
quency using the keypad and [SPLIT].
The transmit frequency can be monitored while pushing
[XFC] or using dualwatch.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
wq.eqp.pp
1
1
SPLITSPLIT
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
wq.wop.pp
1
1
SPLITSPLIT
TXTX
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
wq.wop.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
VFOVFO
qr.wpt.pp
1
1
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
When you are searching for DX stations and you
suspect that a DX station may say “up ‘X’ kHz” for
their receive frequency:
OPERATION 1
q Push [SPLIT] for 1 sec. to standby for split oper-
ation.
w If the DX station’s operator says “up 10 kHz”:
Push [1], [0] then [SPLIT].
•Or, rotate the tuning dial.
OPERATION 2
If the DX station’s operator says “down 5 kHz” be-
fore you enter standby for split operation:
Push [(F-INP)ENT], [•], [5] then [SPLIT].
The split function is turned ON and “5 kHz down” fre-
quency is entered in the sub readout.
PRACTICAL EXAMPLE
When you receive a pile-up and you want to start
split frequency operation to simplify picking out sta-
tions:
q Push [SPLIT] momentarily and push [CHANGE]
for 1 sec.
The sub readout frequency is equalized to the main
readout frequency and “ ” appears.
w Rotate the tuning dial to set your receive fre-
quency in the main readout.
e Announce your receive frequency.
r After you catch one of the calling stations’ call
signs, push and hold the PTT switch to respond.
While pushing [XFC], you can monitor your transmit
frequency.
SPLIT
SPLIT
PRACTICAL EXAMPLE
When you find a DX station, an important considera-
tion is how to set the split frequency.
When you push the [SPLIT] switch for 1 sec., split fre-
quency operation is turned ON, the sub readout is
equalized to the main readout frequency and enters
standby for transmit frequency input.
This shortens the time needed to start split frequency
operation.
The quick split function is ON by default. For your con-
venience, it can be turned OFF in set mode. (p. 100)
In this case, the [SPLIT] switch does not equalize the
main and sub readout frequencies.
[XFC][CHANGE]
[(F-INP)ENT][SPLIT]
6
7
73
VOICE RECORDER FUNCTIONS
Digital voice recorder
The transceiver has a total of 8 memory channels, 4
each for transmit and receive, of digital voice memo-
ries. A maximum message length of 15 sec. can be
recorded in each receive channel, and a total message
length of 90 sec. can be recorded in transmit channels.
Providing a transmission memory is very convenient
for repeated CQ and number transmissions at contest
times, as well as when making consecutive calls in
DX’pedition.
Recording a received audio
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select the desired mode by pushing [SSB],
[CW/RTTY] or [AM/FM].
e Push [(F-2)VOICE] to call up the voice recorder
screen.
If the transmit voice memory channel (T1–T4) appears,
push [(F-5)T/R] to select receive voice memory chan-
nel.
r Push the desired memory channel switch,
[(F-1)R1][(F-4)R4], for 1 sec. to start recording.
“REC” flashes and the recording timer counts up.
The operating frequency, mode and current time are
programmed as the memory names automatically.
Previously recorded contents are cleared.
t Push the selected memory channel switch,
[(F-1)R1][(F-4)R4], again to stop recording.
Recording is automatically terminated after 30 min.
IMPORTANT!
Push one of [(F-1)R1][(F-4)R4] to stop record-
ing before, or when 15 sec. has passed from the
start of recording.
The voice recorder memory records the 15 sec.
(max.) of audio before one of [(F-1)R1][(F-4)
R4] is pushed.
For example, when recording 20 sec. of audio,
the first 5 sec. audio will be over-recorded with
the last 5 sec., so that the total of audio
recorded is 15 sec. only.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the voice memory
screen.
•Playing the recorded audio
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-2)VOICE] to call up the voice recorder
screen.
If the transmit voice memory channel (T1–T4) appears,
push [(F-5)T/R] to select receive voice memory chan-
nel.
e Push the desired memory channel switch,
[(F-1)R1][(F-4)R4], momentarily to playback.
“PLAY” appears.
r Push the selected memory channel switch,
[(F-1)R1][(F-4)R4], again to stop playback if de-
sired.
Playback is terminated automatically when all of the
recorded contents in the channel are played, or after
15 sec.
t Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the voice memory
screen.
VOICE RECORDERVOICE RECORDER
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
R1R1
R2R2
R3R3 R4R4
T/RT/R
PLAYPLAY
R1R1 14.195.0014.195.00 USBUSB 10:1010:10 5s5s
R2R2
------
R3R3
------
R4R4
------
RXRX MEMORYMEMORY
R1R1
R2R2
R3 R4R4
T/RT/R
VOICE RECORDERVOICE RECORDER
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
R1R1 14.100.0014.100.00 USBUSB 15:3015:30 8s8s
R2R2
------
R3R3
------
R4R4
------
RXRX MEMORYMEMORY
VOICE RECORDER
VOICE RECORDER
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
R1
R1
R2
R2
R3
R3
R4
R4
T/R
T/R
REC
REC
R1
R1
14.195.00
14.195.00
USB
USB
10:10
10:10
10s
10s
R2
R2
---
---
R3
R3
---
---
R4
R4
---
---
RX
RX
MEMORY
MEMORY
R1
R1
R2
R2
R3
R3
R4
R4
T/R
T/R
VOICE RECORDER
VOICE RECORDER
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
R1
R1
14.100.00
14.100.00
USB
USB
15:30
15:30
8s
8s
R2
R2
---
---
R3
R3
---
---
R4
R4
---
---
RX
RX
MEMORY
MEMORY
74
7
VOICE RECORDER FUNCTIONS
7
One-touch voice recording
To record the receiving signal contents immediately,
one-touch voice recording is available.
q Push [REC/PLAY] for 1 sec. while receiving a sig-
nal to start recording.
“REC” flashes.
Records audio into the channel R4.
w Push [REC/PLAY] momentarily to stop recording.
Recording is automatically terminated after 30 min.
IMPORTANT!
Push [REC/PLAY] to stop recording before, or
when 15 sec. has passed from the start of
recording.
•One-touch playback
The recorded audio in the channel R4 can be play-
back without selecting the voice memory screen.
q Push [REC/PLAY] to playback.
“PLAY” appears.
Playback the recorded audio in the channel R4.
w Push [REC/PLAY] again to stop playback if de-
sired.
Playback is terminated automatically when all of the
recorded contents in the channel R4 are played, or
after 15 sec.
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
RECREC
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
SCOPESCOPE
VOICEVOICE
MEMORYMEMORY
SCANSCAN
qw:pp
12:00
[REC/PLAY]
Digital voice recorder (continued)
75
7
VOICE RECORDER FUNCTIONS
Digital voice recorder (continued)
Recording a message for transmit
To transmit a message using a voice recorder, record
the desired message in advance as described below.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-2)VOICE] to call up the voice recorder
screen.
e Push [(F-2)MIC REC] to select the voice memory
recording screen.
r Push the desired memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], for 1 sec. to start recording.
Speak into the microphone without pushing the [PTT]
switch.
Previously recorded contents are cleared.
t Adjust the [MIC GAIN] control so that the [REC
LEVEL] indicator reads within 100%.
y Push the selected memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], again to stop recording.
Recording is automatically terminated when the total
time of recorded messages, T1–T4, becomes 90 sec.
u Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the voice memory
screen.
Confirming a message for transmit
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-2)VOICE] to call up the voice recorder
screen.
e Push [(F-2)MIC REC] to select the voice memory
recording screen.
r Push the desired memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], momentarily to start playback
and confirmation.
t Push the selected memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], again to stop playback if de-
sired.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the voice memory
screen.
Programming a memory name for
transmit
Memory channels can be tagged with alphanumeric
names of up to 20 characters each.
Capital letters, small letters, numerals, some symbols
(! # $ % & ¥ ? " ' ` ^ + – /
.,
: ; = < > ( ) [ ] { } | _
_
@)
and spaces can be used. (See step t below.)
q Record a message as described at left.
w Call up the voice memory recording screen as de-
scribed in steps q to e at left.
e Push [(F-5)NAME] to enter memory name edit
condition.
•Acursor appears and blinks.
r Push [(F-5)T1..T4] several times to select the de-
sired voice memory.
t Input the desired character by rotating the tuning
dial or by pushing the band key for number input.
Push [ABC] or [abc] to toggle capital and small letters.
Push [123] or [etc] to toggle numerals and symbols.
Push [(F-1)
] or [(F-2)
] for cursor movement.
Push [(F-3)DEL] to delete the selected character.
Push [(F-4)SPACE] to input a space.
Pushing the transceiver’s keypad, [0][9], can also
enter numerals.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to input and set the name.
The cursor disappears.
u Repeat steps r to y to program another voice
memory’s name, if desired.
i Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the voice memory
screen.
ABCABC
123123
T4T4 -
-
-
T1T1 10s10s
T3T3
-
-
-
VOICE MIC-RECORDVOICE MIC-RECORD
T2T2 -
-
-
ABCABC
ç
å
DELDEL
SPACESPACE
T1..T4T1..T4
Character
group
keys
Selected
character
VOICE MIC-RECORDVOICE MIC-RECORD
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
RECREC LEVELLEVEL
0
5050
100100
% % RemainRemain
80s 80s
T1T1
T2T2
T3T3 T4T4
NAMENAME
PLAYPLAY
T1T1 10s10s
T2T2
------
T3T3
------
T4T4
------
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
RECREC LEVELLEVEL
0
5050
100100
% % RemainRemain
80s 80s
VOICE MIC-RECORDVOICE MIC-RECORD
T1T1
T2T2
T3T3 T4T4
NAMENAME
RECREC
T1T1 10s10s
T2T2
------
T3T3
------
T4T4 ------
VOICE MIC-RECORDVOICE MIC-RECORD
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
RECREC LEVELLEVEL
0
5050
100100
% % RemainRemain
90s 90s
T1T1
T2T2
T3T3 T4T4
NAMENAME
T1T1 ------
T2T2
------
T3T3
------
T4T4
------
VOICE RECORDERVOICE RECORDER
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
PLAYPLAY
MIC RECMIC REC
TX LEV.TX LEV.
SETSET
VOICE RECORDER MENUVOICE RECORDER MENU
PLAY PLAY TX Variable TX Variable 4ch (Total 90s) 4ch (Total 90s)
RX 15s Endless RX 15s Endless 4ch (TOT 30m) 4ch (TOT 30m)
MIC REC Mic Record/Record check MIC REC Mic Record/Record check
TX LEV. Recorder Output Adjust TX LEV. Recorder Output Adjust
SET Auto Monitor SET SET Auto Monitor SET
76
7
VOICE RECORDER FUNCTIONS
7
Digital voice recorder (continued)
Sending a message for transmit
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select a phone mode by pushing [SSB] or
[AM/FM].
e Push [(F-2)VOICE] to call up the voice recorder
screen.
If the receive voice memory channel (R1–R4) appears,
push [(F-5)T/R] to select transmit voice memory chan-
nel.
r Push the desired memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], momentarily to transmit the
contents.
t Push the selected memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], again to stop, if desired.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the voice memory
screen.
For your information
When an external keypad is connected to the pin 3
and pin 7 of the [MIC] connecter, the recorded
message, T1–T4, can be transmitted without open-
ing the voice recorder set screen.
See page 104 for details.
•Transmit monitor function
The monitor function can be automatically turned ON
while transmitting a voice memory message.
q Call up the voice recorder screen as described at
left.
w Push [EXIT/SET] then [(F-5)SET] to select the
voice recorder set screen.
e Rotate the tuning dial to turn the monitor function
ON and OFF.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select the default condi-
tion.
r Push [EXIT/SET] to return to the voice recorder
screen.
•Transmit level setting
q Call up the voice recorder screen as described at
left.
w Push [(F-3)TX LEV.] to select the voice memory
transmit level set mode screen.
e Push the desired memory channel switch,
[(F-1)T1][(F-4)T4], momentarily to transmit the
contents.
r Rotate the tuning dial to adjust the transmit voice
level.
Push [(F-5)DEF] to select the default condition.
t Push [EXIT/SET] to return to the voice recorder
screen.
VOICE RECORDERVOICE RECORDER
TXTX_LEVELLEVEL 50%50%
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
T1T1
T2T2
T3T3 T4T4
DEFDEF
SENDSEND
T1T1 CQCQ JA3YUAJA3YUA 10s10s
T2T2
------
T3T3
------
T4T4
------
VOICE RECORDERVOICE RECORDER
TXTX LEVELLEVEL 50%50%
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
T1T1
T2T2
T3T3 T4T4
DEFDEF
T1T1 CQCQ JA3YUAJA3YUA 10s10s
T2T2
------
T3T3
------
T4T4
------
VOICE SET
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
DEFDEF
AutoAutoMonitorMonitor ONON
VOICE RECORDER
VOICE RECORDER
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
T1
T1
T2
T2
T3
T3
T4
T4
T/R
T/R
SEND
SEND
TX
TX
MEMORY
MEMORY
T1
T1
CQ JA3YUA
CQ JA3YUA
10s
10s
T2
T2
---
---
T3
T3
---
---
T4
T4
---
---
VOICE RECORDER
VOICE RECORDER
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
T1
T1
T2
T2
T3
T3
T4
T4
T/R
T/R
T1
T1
CQ JA3YUA
CQ JA3YUA
10s
10s
T2
T2
---
---
T3
T3
---
---
T4
T4
---
---
TX
TX
MEMORY
MEMORY
Memory channels
The transceiver has 101 memory channels. The mem-
ory mode is very useful for quickly changing to often-
used frequencies.
All 101 memory channels are tuneable which means
the programmed frequency can be tuned temporarily
with the tuning dial, etc. in memory mode.
Memory channel selection
Using the [
YY
] or [
ZZ
] keys
q Push [VFO/MEMO] to select memory mode.
w Push [
YY
]/[
ZZ
] several times to select the desired
memory channel.
Push and hold [
YY
]/[
ZZ
] for continuous selection.
[UP] and [DN] on the microphone can also be used.
e To return to VFO mode, push [VFO/MEMO] again.
Using the keypad
q Push [VFO/MEMO] to select memory mode.
w Push [(F-INP)ENT].
e Push the desired memory channel number using
the keypad.
Enter 100 or 101 to select scan edge channel P1 or P2,
respectively.
r Push [
YY
] or [
ZZ
] to select the desired memory
channel.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
BPFBPF
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
500 500
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
wr.oyp.pp
1212
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
CWCW
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
VFO/
MEMO
or
F-INP
ENT
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
CWCW
qr.qpp.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
CWCW
.qpp.qw
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
wr.oyp.pp
1212
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
CWCW
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
1
2
or
then
MEMORY
MEMORY
TRANSFER OVER-
CHANNEL
CHANNEL CAPABILITY
TO VFO WRITING
CLEAR
NUMBER
Regular memory
1–99
One frequency and one mode
Yes Yes Yes
channels in each memory channel.
Scan edge
One frequency and one mode in
memory P1, P2 each memory channel as scan Yes Yes No
channels edges for programmed scan.
8
77
MEMORY OPERATION
78
8
MEMORY OPERATION
8
Memory channel screen
The memory channel screen simultaneously shows 7
memory channels and their programmed contents. 13
memory channels can be displayed in the wide mem-
ory channel screen.
You can select a desired memory channel from the
memory channel screen.
Selecting a memory channel using the
memory channel screen
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-4)MEMORY] to select the memory chan-
nel screen.
[(F-5)WIDE] switches the standard and wide screens.
e Rotate the tuning dial while pushing [(F-2)SET] to
select the desired memory channel.
[
YY
] and [
ZZ
] can also be used.
r Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the memory channel
screen.
Confirming programmed memory
channels
q Select the memory channel screen as described
above.
w Rotate the tuning dial while pushing [(F-1)ROLL]
to scroll the screen.
e Push [(F-2)SET] to select the highlighted memory
channel, if desired.
r Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the memory channel
screen.
Setting a memory channel as a select
memory
Select memory channels are used for select memory
scan. Select memory scan repeatedly scans the se-
lect memory channels only. This is useful to speed up
the memory scan interval. Of course, select memory
channels are also scanned during normal memory
scan.
q Select the memory channel screen as described at
left.
w Rotate the tuning dial while pushing [(F-1)ROLL]
or [(F-2)SET] to select the desired memory chan-
nel.
[
YY
] and [
ZZ
] can also be used.
e Push [(F-3)SELECT] to set the memory channel
as a select memory or not.
r Repeat steps w to e to program another memory
channel as a select memory channel, if desired.
t Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the memory channel
screen.
Setting select memory channels is also possible in
the scan screen.
ROLL
ROLL
SET
SET
SELECT
SELECT
NAME
NAME
WIDE
WIDE
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
1
ß
ß
VFO
VFO
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
99
99
--.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
P1
P1
0.500.00
0.500.00
LSB
LSB
FL2
FL2
SCAN EDGE
SCAN EDGE
P2
P2
29.999.99
29.999.99
USB
USB
FL2
FL2
SCAN EDGE
SCAN EDGE
1 ß 14.100.00
14.100.00
USB
USB
FL2
FL2
2 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
3 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
4 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
MEMORY
MEMORY
ANT
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
qw:pp
12:00
ß” appears for select memory channel.
ROLL
ROLL
SET
SET
SELECT
SELECT
NAME
NAME
WIDE
WIDE
99
99
--.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
P1
P1
0.500.00
0.500.00
LSB
LSB
FL2
FL2
SCAN EDGE
SCAN EDGE
P2
P2
29.999.99
29.999.99
USB
USB
FL2
FL2
SCAN EDGE
SCAN EDGE
1 ß 14.100.00
14.100.00
USB
USB
FL2
FL2
2 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
3 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
4 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
MEMORY
MEMORY
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
“ ” appears when the memory
channel is selected.
ROLL
ROLL
SET
SET
SELECT
SELECT
NAME
NAME
WIDE
WIDE
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
1
VFO
VFO
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
99
99
--.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
P1
P1
0.500.00
0.500.00
LSB
LSB
FL2
FL2
SCAN EDGE
SCAN EDGE
P2
P2
29.999.99
29.999.99
USB
USB
FL2
FL2
SCAN EDGE
SCAN EDGE
1 14.100.00
14.100.00
USB
USB
FL2
FL2
2 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
3 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
4 --.---.--
--.---.--
------
------
---
---
MEMORY
MEMORY
ANT
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
qw:pp
12:00
79
8
MEMORY OPERATION
Memory channel programming
Memory channel programming can be preformed ei-
ther in VFO mode or in memory mode.
Programming in VFO mode
q Set the desired frequency and operating mode in
VFO mode.
w Push [
YY
]/[
ZZ
] several times to select the desired
memory channel.
•Memory channel contents appear in the memory chan-
nel readout (below the frequency readout).
Memory channel screen is convenient for selecting the
desired channel.
“--.---.--” appears if the selected memory channel is a
blank channel (and does not have contents).
e Push [MW] for 1 sec. to program the displayed fre-
quency and operating mode into the memory
channel.
[EXAMPLE]: Programming 7.088 MHz/LSB into
memory channel 12.
7
3
SSB
MW
or
Push for 1 sec.
Beep
Beep
Beep
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
qw:pp
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qpp.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
LSBLSB
TXTX
USBUSB
u.pii.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
LSBLSB
TXTX
u.pii.pp
--.---.----.---.--
1212
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
LSBLSB
TXTX
LSBLSB
u.pii.pp
7.088.007.088.00
1212
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
Programming in memory mode
q Select the desired memory channel with [
YY
]/[
ZZ
]
in memory mode.
“--.---.--” appears if the selected memory channel is a
blank channel (and does not have contents).
w Set the desired frequency and operating mode in
memory mode.
•To program a blank channel, use direct frequency entry
with the keypad or memo pads, etc.
e Push [MW] for 1 sec. to program the displayed
frequency and operating mode into the memory
channel.
[EXAMPLE]: Programming 21.280 MHz/USB into
memory channel 18.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
LSBLSB
TXTX
USBUSB
u.pii.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1212
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
USBUSB
e.tpw.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1818
BWBW
500500
BPFBPF
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
wq.wip.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1818
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
wq.wip.pp
14.195.0014.195.00
1818
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
21
7
MW
or
Push for 1 sec.
Beep
Beep
Beep
SSB
80
8
MEMORY OPERATION
8
Frequency transferring
The frequency and operating mode in a memory chan-
nel can be transferred to the VFO.
Frequency transferring can be performed in either VFO
mode or memory mode.
•Transferring in VFO mode
This is useful for transferring programmed contents to
VFO.
q Select VFO mode with [VFO/MEMO].
w Select the memory channel to be transferred with
[
YY
]/[
ZZ
].
•Memory channel contents appear in the memory chan-
nel readout (below the frequency readout).
Memory channel screen is convenient for selecting the
desired channel.
“--.---.--” appears if the selected memory channel is a
blank channel. In this case transferring is impossible.
e Push [VFO/MEMO] for 1 sec. to transfer the fre-
quency and operating mode.
•Transferred frequency and operating mode appear on
the frequency readout.
TRANSFERRING EXAMPLE IN VFO MODE
Operating frequency : 21.320 MHz/USB (VFO)
Contents of M-ch 16 : 14.018 MHz/CW
or
Push for 1 sec.
Beep
Beep
Beep
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
wq.ewp.pp
14.950.0014.950.00
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
CWCW
wq.ewp.pp
14.018.0014.018.00
1616
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
CWCW
qr.pqi.pp
14.018.0014.018.00
1616
VFOVFO
BWBW
500500
BPFBPF
ANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
VFO/
MEMO
•Transferring in memory mode
This is useful for transferring frequency and operat-
ing mode while operating in memory mode.
When you have changed the frequency or operat-
ing mode in the selected memory channel:
Displayed frequency and mode are transferred.
Programmed frequency and mode in the mem-
ory channel are not transferred, and they remain
in the memory channel.
q Select the memory channel to be transferred with
[
YY
]/[
ZZ
] in memory mode.
And, set the frequency or operating mode if required.
w Push [VFO/MEMO] for 1 sec. to transfer the fre-
quency and operating mode.
Displayed frequency and operating mode are trans-
ferred to the VFO.
e To return to VFO mode, push [VFO/MEMO] mo-
mentarily.
TRANSFERRING EXAMPLE IN MEMORY MODE
Operating frequency : 14.020 MHz/CW (M-ch 16)
Contents of M-ch 16 : 14.018 MHz/CW
Push for 1 sec.
Programmed contents appear.
Beep
Beep
Beep
VFO/
MEMO
VFO/
MEMO
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.pwp.pp
21.320.0021.320.00
VFOVFO
1616
BWBW
500500
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
CWCW
qr.pwp.pp
14.018.0014.018.00
1616
VFOVFO
BWBW
500500
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
CWCW
qr.pwp.pp
14.020.0014.020.00
VFOVFO
1616
BWBW
500500
BPFBPF
BPFBPF
BPFBPF
ANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANT
1
METERMETER
Po
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
81
8
MEMORY OPERATION
Memory names
All memory channels (including scan edges) can be
tagged with alphanumeric names of up to 10 charac-
ters each.
Capital letters, small letters, numerals, some symbols
(! # $ % & ¥ ? " ’ ` ^ + – /
.,
: ; = < > ( ) [ ] { } | _
_
)
and spaces can be used.
Editing (programming) memory names
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-4)MEMORY] to select the memory chan-
nel screen.
e Select the desired memory channel.
r Push [(F-4)NAME] to edit memory channel name.
•Acursor appears and blinks.
•Memory channel names of blank channels cannot be
edited.
t Input the desired character by rotating the tuning
dial or by pushing the band key for number input.
Push [ABC] or [abc] to toggle capital and small letters.
Push [123] or [etc] to toggle numerals and symbols.
Push [(F-1)
] or [(F-2)
] for cursor movement.
Push [(F-3)DEL] to delete the selected character.
Push [(F-4)SPACE] to input a space.
Pushing the transceiver’s keypad, [0][9], can also
enter numerals.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to input and set the name.
The cursor disappears.
u Repeat steps e to y to program another memory
channel’s name, if desired.
i Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the memory channel
screen.
123123
ABCABC
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
9999 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
P1P1 0.500.000.500.00 LSBLSB FL2FL2 SCAN EDGESCAN EDGE
P2P2 29.999.9929.999.99 USBUSB FL2FL2 SCAN EDGESCAN EDGE
1 14.100.0014.100.00 USBUSB FL2FL2 _
2 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
3 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
4 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
MEMORYMEMORY
ç
å
DELDEL
SPACESPACE WIDEWIDE
ABCABC
qw:pp
12:00
Character
group
keys
Selected
character
ROLLROLL
SETSET
SELECTSELECT
NAMENAME
WIDEWIDE
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
9999 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
P1P1 0.500.000.500.00 LSBLSB FL2FL2 SCAN EDGESCAN EDGE
P2P2 29.999.9929.999.99 USBUSB FL2FL2 SCAN EDGESCAN EDGE
1 14.100.0014.100.00 USBUSB FL2FL2
2 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
3 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
4 --.---.----.---.-- ------------ ------
MEMORYMEMORY
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
Memory clearing
Any unnecessary memory channels can be cleared.
The cleared memory channels become blank chan-
nels.
q Select memory mode with [VFO/MEMO].
w Select the desired memory channel with [
YY
]/[
ZZ
].
e Push [M-CL] for 1 sec. to clear the contents.
The programmed frequency and operating mode dis-
appear.
r To clear other memory channels, repeat steps w
and e.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
wr.oyp.pp
1212
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SFTSFT
0
TXTX
CWCW
qotpp
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
1212
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
CWCW
14.195.0014.195.00
VFOVFO
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
qw:pp
12:00
qw:pp
12:00
Push for 1 sec.
M-CL
Beep
Beep
Beep
82
8
MEMORY OPERATION
8
Memo pads
The transceiver has a memo pad function to store fre-
quency and operating mode for easy write and recall.
The memo pads are separate from memory channels.
The default number of memo pads is 5, however, this
can be increased to 10 in set mode if desired. (p. 102)
Memo pads are convenient when you want to memo-
rize a frequency and operating mode temporarily, such
as when you find a DX station in a pile-up, or when a
desired station is busy for a long time and you want to
temporarily search for other stations.
Use the transceivers memo pads instead of relying on
hastily scribbled notes that are easily misplaced.
•Writing frequencies and operating
modes into memo pads
You can simply write the accessed readout frequency
and operating mode by pushing [MP-W].
When you write a 6th frequency and operating mode,
the oldest written frequency and operating mode are
automatically erased to make room for the new set-
tings.
Each memo pad must have its own unique combi-
nation of frequency and operating mode; memo
pads having identical settings cannot be written.
Displayed frequency and mode
Push
Newest
The oldest written frequency
and mode are erased.
Oldest
MP-W
wq.wii.ww
USB
wq.wuy.pp
USB
wq.pwr.tw
USB
wq.pqi.py
USB
qr.qiw.rp
USB
qr.qot.pp
USB
MEMO
PADS
Calling up a frequency from a memo pad
You can simply call up the desired frequency and op-
erating mode of a memo pad by pushing [MP-R] sev-
eral times.
Both VFO and memory modes can be used.
The frequency and operating mode are called up, starting
from the most recently written.
When you call up a frequency and an operating mode
from memo pads with [MP-R], the previously dis-
played frequency and operating mode are automati-
cally stored in a temporary pad. The frequency and
operating mode in the temporary pad can be recalled
by pushing [MP-R] several times.
•You may think there are 6 memo pads because 6 different
frequencies (5 are in memo pads and 1 is in the tempo-
rary pad) are called up by [MP-R].
If you change the frequency or operating mode
called up from a memo pad with the tuning dial,
etc., the frequency and operating mode in the tem-
porary pad are erased.
VFO or MEMORY
mode display
MEMO PADS
TEMPORARY PAD
Push
Pushing [MP-R] calls up the
frequency and operating
mode in a memo pad and
the temporary pad sequen-
tially.
Frequency and mode before
pushing [
MP-R].
MP-R
wq.rit.pp
USB
qr.qot.pp
USB
wq.wuy.pp
USB
wq.pwr.tw
USB
wq.pqi.py
USB
qr.qiw.rp
USB
qr.qot.pp
USB
Scan types
Preparation
Channels
For programmed scan:
Program scan edge frequencies into scan edge mem-
ory channels P1 and P2.
For
F scan:
Set the F span (F scan range) in the scan screen.
For memory scan:
Program 2 or more memory channels except scan
edge memory channels.
For select memory scan:
Designate 2 or more memory channels as select mem-
ory channels. To designate the channel as a select
memory channel, choose a memory channel, then
push [(F-3)SELECT] in the scan screen (memory
mode) or in the memory channel screen.
Scan resume ON/OFF
You can select the scan to resume or cancel when de-
tecting a signal, in set mode. Scan resume ON/OFF
must be set before operating a scan. See p. 87 for
ON/OFF setting and scan resume condition details.
Scan speed
Scan speed can be selected from 2 levels, high or low,
in set mode. See p. 87 for details.
Squelch condition
The scan function can be used on the main readout only.
•You can operate a scan while operating on a frequency using
the dualwatch or split functions. See p. 63 for details.
PROGRAMMED SCAN
Repeatedly scans between two scan edge frequencies
(scan edge memory channels P1 and P2).
This scan operates in VFO mode.
SELECT MEMORY SCAN
Repeatedly scans all select memory channels.
F SCAN
Repeatedly scans within F span area.
This scan operates in memory mode.This scan operates in memory mode.
This scan operates in both VFO and memory modes.
Scan
Scan edge
P1 or P2
Scan edge
P2 or P1
Jump
Mch 1 Mch 5
Mch 2 Mch 3 Mch 4
Mch 6Mch 7Mch 99
MEMORY SCAN
Repeatedly scans all programmed memory channels.
Mch 1 Mch 5
Mch 2 Mch 3 Mch 4
Mch 6Mch 7Mch 99
ß (select)
ß (select)ß (select)
ß (select)
ß (select)
Blank channel Blank channel
ß (select)
ß (select)ß (select)
ß (select)
ß (select)
ScanScan
F frequency +F frequency
Start frequency
Jump
SQUELCH
CLOSED
SQUELCH
OPEN
Scan stops when detecting a signal.
If you set scan resume ON in set mode, the
scan pauses for 10 sec. when detecting a
signal, then resumes. When a signal disap-
pears while scan is paused, scan resumes
2 sec. later.
The scan continues
until it is stopped
manually, and does
not pause even if it
detects signals.
Scan pauses on
each channel when
the scan resume is
ON; not applicable
when OFF.
SCAN
PROGRAMMED
STARTS
SCAN
MEMORY SCAN
WITH
9
83
SCANS
84
9
SCANS
9
Programmed scan operation
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select VFO mode.
e Select the desired operating mode.
The operating mode can also be changed while scan-
ning.
r Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
t Set [RF/SQL] open or closed.
See previous page for scan condition.
If the [RF/SQL] control function is set as “AUTO,” the
squelch is always open in SSB, CW and RTTY modes.
See pgs. 2, 30, 99 for details.
y Push [(F-1)PROG] to start the programmed scan.
Decimal points blink while scanning.
u When the scan detects a signal, the scan stops,
pauses or ignores it depending on the resume set-
ting and the squelch condition.
i To cancel the scan, push [(F-1)PROG].
If the same frequencies are programmed into the
scan edge memory channel P1 and P2, pro-
grammed scan does not start.
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
1
VFO
VFO
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
PROG
PROG
F FINE
FINE
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
PROGRAM SCAN
PROGRAM SCAN
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
PROG
PROG
F FINE
FINE
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
SCAN
SCAN
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
F scan operation
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select VFO mode or a memory channel.
e Select the desired operating mode.
The operating mode can also be changed while scan-
ning.
r Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
t Set [RF/SQL] open or closed.
See previous page for scan condition.
If the [RF/SQL] control function is set as “AUTO,” the
squelch is always open in SSB, CW and RTTY modes.
See pgs. 2, 30, 99 for details.
y Set the F span by pushing [(F-4)
F SPAN].
•±5 kHz, ±10 kHz, ±20 kHz, ±50 kHz, ±100 kHz,
±500 kHz and ±1000 kHz are selectable.
u Set center frequency of the F span.
i Push [(F-2)
F] to start the F scan.
Decimal points blink while scanning.
o When the scan detects a signal, the scan stops,
pauses or ignores it depending on the resume set-
ting and the squelch condition.
!0 To cancel the scan, push [(F-2)
F].
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SCANSCAN
ANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
Po
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
PROGPROG
F FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
qw:pp
12:00
F SCANSCAN
F CenterCenter: 14.195.00MHz14.195.00MHz
F SpanSpan: ±±10kHz10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1:0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scanscan edgesedges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
PROGPROG
F FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
SCANSCAN
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
F SpanSpan: ±±10kHz10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1:0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scanscan edgesedges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
85
9
SCANS
Fine programmed scan/fine F scan
Fine scan functions as programmed or F scan, but
scan speed decreases when the squelch opens but
does not stop. The scanning tuning step shifts from
50 Hz to 10 Hz while the squelch opens.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
e Set for programmed scan or F scan as described
on previous page.
r Push [(F-1)PROG] or [(F-2)
F] to start a scan.
Decimal points blink while scanning.
t Push [(F-3)FINE] to start a fine scan.
•“FINE PROGRAM SCAN” or “FINE F SCAN” ap-
pears.
y When the scan detects a signal, the scan speed
decreases but does not stop.
u Push [(F-1)PROG] or [(F-2)
F] to stop the scan;
push [(F-3)FINE] to cancel the fine scan.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SCANSCAN
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
Po
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
PROGPROG
F FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
qw:pp
12:00
FINE PROGRAM SCANFINE PROGRAM SCAN
F SpanSpan: ±±10kHz10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1:0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scanscan edgesedges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
SCANSCAN
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
PROGPROG
F FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
qw:pp
12:00
PROGRAM SCANPROGRAM SCAN
F SpanSpan: ±±10kHz10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1:0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scanscan edgesedges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
Memory scan operation
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select memory mode.
e Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
r Set [RF/SQL] open or closed.
See p. 83 for scan condition.
If the [RF/SQL] control function is set as “AUTO,” the
squelch is always open in SSB, CW and RTTY modes.
See pgs. 2, 30, 99 for details.
t Push [(F-1)MEMO] to start the memory scan.
Decimal points blink while scanning.
y When the scan detects a signal, the scan stops,
pauses or ignores it depending on the resume set-
ting and the squelch condition.
u To cancel the scan, push [(F-1)MEMO].
2 or more memory channels must be programmed
for memory scan to start.
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
VFO
VFO
12
12
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
ANT
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
MEMO
MEMO
F SELECT
SELECT
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
MEMORY SCAN
MEMORY SCAN
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
VFO
VFO
12
12
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
ANT
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
MEMO
MEMO
F SELECT
SELECT
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
86
9
SCANS
9
Select memory scan operation
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select memory mode.
e Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
r Set [RF/SQL] open or closed.
See p. 83 for scan condition.
If the [RF/SQL] control function is set as “AUTO,” the
squelch is always open in SSB, CW and RTTY modes.
See pgs. 2, 30, 99 for details.
t Push [(F-1)MEMO] to start the memory scan.
Decimal points blink while scanning.
y Push [(F-3)SELECT] to start select memory scan;
push [(F-3)SELECT] again to return to memory
scan, if desired.
u When the scan detects a signal, the scan stops,
pauses or ignores it depending on the resume set-
ting and the squelch condition.
i To cancel the scan, push [(F-1)MEMO].
2 or more memory channels must be designated
as select memory channels for select memory
scan to start.
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
VFO
VFO
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
12
12
ß
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
MEMO
MEMO
F SELECT
SELECT
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
SELECT MEMORY SCAN
SELECT MEMORY SCAN
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
VFO
VFO
12
12
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
ANT
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
MEMO
MEMO
F SELECT
SELECT
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
Setting select memory channels
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Select memory mode.
e Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
r Select the desired memory channel to set as a se-
lect memory channel.
t Push [(F-3)SELECT] to set the memory channel
as a select memory or not.
y Repeat steps r to t to program another memory
channel as a select memory channel, if desired.
u Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the scan screen.
Select memory channels can also be set in the
memory channel screen. (p. 78)
12
12
ß
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
VFO
VFO
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
MEMO
MEMO
F SELECT
SELECT
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
ß” appears for select memory channels.
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
SFT
SFT
0
FIL2
FIL2
USB
USB
TX
TX
VFO
VFO
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
USB
FIL2
FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
14.100.00
1
VFO
VFO
12
12
BW
BW
2.4k
2.4k
SCAN
SCAN
ANT
ANT
1
COMP
COMP
OFF
OFF
WIDE
WIDE
METER
METER
Po
Po
P.AMP
P.AMP
1
AGC
AGC
MID
MID
ATT
ATT
OFF
OFF
VOX
VOX
OFF
OFF
MEMO
MEMO
F SELECT
SELECT
F SPAN
F SPAN
SET
SET
qw:pp
12:00
F Span
Span


: ±
±
10kHz
10kHz
Programmed
Programmed
P1:
P1:


0.500.00MHz
0.500.00MHz
scan
scan
edges
edges
P2:
P2:
29.999.99MHz
29.999.99MHz
87
9
SCANS
Scan set mode
Scan set mode is used for programming scanning
speed and scan resume condition.
Scan speed
The transceiver has 2 speeds for scanning, high and
low.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
e Push [(F-5)SET] to select the scan set mode
screen.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] to select the scan speed item.
t Rotate the tuning dial to select the scan speed.
Push [(F-3)DEF] to select the default condition.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the scan set mode.
Scan resume condition
This item sets the scan resume function ON or OFF.
ON: scan resumes 10 sec. after stopping on a signal
(or 1 sec. after a signal disappears); OFF: scan does
not resume after stopping on a signal.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [(F-5)SCAN] to select the scan screen.
e Push [(F-5)SET] to select the scan set mode
screen.
r Push [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the scan resume condition
item.
t Rotate the tuning dial to turn the scan resume
function ON or OFF.
Push [(F-3)DEF] to select the default condition.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the scan set mode.
é
è
DEF
SCAN SET
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGC
MID
VOX
OFF
SCAN SpeedSCAN Speed HIGHHIGH
SCAN ResumeSCAN Resume ONON
é
è
DEF
SCAN SET
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
SCAN SpeedSCAN Speed HIGHHIGH
SCAN ResumeSCAN Resume ONON
PROGPROG
F FINEFINE
F SPANF SPAN
SETSET
SCANSCAN
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
F SpanSpan: ±±10kHz10kHz
ProgrammedProgrammed P1:P1:0.500.00MHz0.500.00MHz
scanscan edgesedges P2:P2: 29.999.99MHz29.999.99MHz
Tone scan
The transceiver can detect the subaudible tone fre-
quency in a received signal. By monitoring a signal
that is being transmitted on a repeater input fre-
quency, you can determine the tone frequency re-
quired to access the repeater.
q Set the desired frequency or memory channel to
be checked for a tone frequency.
w Push [AM/FM] several times to select FM mode.
e Push [TONE] for 1 sec. to enter the tone fre-
quency screen.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to check the repeater
tone frequency or tone squelch frequency, respec-
tively. (pgs. 52, 53)
t Push [(F-5)T-SCAN] to start the tone scan.
“SCAN” flashes while scanning.
y When the tone frequency is detected, the tone
scan pauses.
The tone frequency is set temporarily on a memory
channel. Program into the memory channel to store the
tone frequency permanently.
The decoded tone frequency is used for the repeater
tone frequency or tone squelch frequency.
u To stop the scan, push [(F-5)T-SCAN].
i Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the tone frequency
screen.
TONE FREQUENCYTONE FREQUENCY
188.8Hz188.8Hz SCANSCAN
88.5Hz88.5HzT-SQL TONET-SQL TONE
REPEATER TONEREPEATER TONE
TONETONE
AGC
FASTFAST
VOX
OFF
T-SCANT-SCAN
T-SCANT-SCAN
é
è
DEFDEF
TONE FREQUENCYTONE FREQUENCY
88.5Hz88.5Hz
88.5Hz88.5HzT-SQL TONET-SQL TONE
REPEATER TONEREPEATER TONE
AGCAGC
FASTFAST
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
TONETONE
OFFOFF
10
88
ANTENNA TUNER OPERATION
Automatic antenna selection
The transceiver covers 0.1–60 MHz over 10 bands.
Each band key has a band memory which can memo-
rize a selected antenna (ANT1, ANT2, ANT1/RX an-
tenna and ANT2/RX antenna). When you change the
operating frequency beyond a band, the previously
used antenna is automatically selected for the new
band. This function is convenient when you use 2 or 3
antennas.
To use the band memory, enter set mode and confirm
that “Auto” is selected as the [ANT] switch item.
(p. 101)
When OFF is selected, the [ANT] switch does not function
and [ANT1] is always selected.
•When “Manual” is selected, the [ANT] switch functions,
however, band memory does not function. In this case, you
must select an antenna manually.
•When “Auto” is selected (default setting), the antenna tuner
ON/OFF condition is also memorized in the band memory.
When “Auto” or “Manual” is selected, the antenna tuner
ON/OFF condition is consistent with the [ANT] switch.
Antenna switch selection example
Under the following condition, “Auto” should be se-
lected as the [ANT] switch set mode item.
- When you use 2 antennas.
Under the following conditions, “Manual” should be se-
lected as the [ANT] switch set mode item.
- When using 1 antenna.
- When using an external antenna selector for more
than 3 antennas (except for receive antenna).
- When using an external antenna tuner.
[ANT]
DEFDEF WIDEWIDE
é
è
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
FMFMSPLITSPLITOffset(HF)Offset(HF) -0.100MHz-0.100MHz
FMFMSPLITSPLITOffset(50M)Offset(50M) -0.500MHz-0.500MHz
SPLITSPLIT LOCKLOCK OFFOFF
TunerTuner (Auto(Auto Start)Start) OFFOFF
TunerTuner (PTT(PTTStart)Start) OFFOFF
[ANT][ANT] SwitchSwitch AutoAuto
RTTYRTTYMark FrequencyMark Frequency 21252125
OTHERSOTHERSSETSET
10
Antenna tuner operation
The internal automatic antenna tuner matches the
transceiver to the connected antenna automatically.
Once the tuner matches an antenna, the variable ca-
pacitor angles are memorized as a preset point for
each frequency range (100 kHz steps). Therefore,
when you change the frequency range, the variable
capacitors are automatically preset to the memorized
point.
CAUTION:
NEVER transmit with the tuner ON
when no antenna is connected. This will damage
the transceiver. Be careful of the antenna selection.
TUNER OPERATION
Push the [TUNER] switch to turn the internal an-
tenna tuner ON. The antenna is tuned automati-
cally when the antenna SWR is higher than 1.5:1.
•When the tuner is ON, the [TUNER] switch lights.
[TUNER]
MANUAL TUNING
During SSB operation at low voice levels, the internal
tuner may not be tuned correctly. In such cases, man-
ual tuning is helpful.
Push [TUNER] for 1 sec., to start manual tuning.
•Aside tone is emitted and [TUNER] blinks while tuning.
If the tuner cannot reduce the SWR to less than 1.5:1
after 20 sec. of tuning, the [TUNER] switch indicator
goes out.
Push [TUNER] for 1 sec.
AUTOMATIC TUNER START (HF bands only)
If you want to deactivate the tuner under conditions
of VSWR 1.5:1 or less, use the auto tuner start func-
tion and turn the tuner OFF. This function activates
the tuner automatically when the SWR exceeds 1.5:1.
This function is turned ON in set mode. (p. 101).
PTT TUNER START
The tuner is always tuned when the PTT is pushed
after the frequency is changed (more than 1% from
last-tuned frequency). This function removes the
“push and hold [TUNER]” operation and activates for
the first transmission on a new frequency.
This function is turned ON in set mode. (p. 101).
NOTES:
•If the tuner cannot tune the antenna
Check the following and try again:
the [ANT] connector selection.
the antenna connection and feedline.
the unaltered antenna SWR. (Less than 3:1 for HF bands;
Less than 2.5:1 for 50 MHz band)
the transmit power. (8 W for HF bands; 15 W for 50 MHz
band)
the power source voltage/capacity.
If the tuner cannot reduce the SWR to less than 1.5:1
after checking the above, perform the following:
repeat manual tuning several times.
tune with a 50 dummy load and re-tune the antenna.
turn power OFF and ON.
adjust the antenna cable length.
(This is effective for higher frequencies in some cases.)
•Tuning a narrow bandwidth antenna
Some antennas, especially for low bands, have a nar-
row bandwidth. These antennas may not be tuned at
the edge of their bandwidth, therefore, tune such an
antenna as follows:
Suppose you have an antenna which has an SWR of
1.5:1 at 3.55 MHz and an SWR of 3:1 at 3.8 MHz.
q Push [TUNER] to turn the antenna tuner ON.
w Select CW mode.
e Turn OFF the break-in function. (pgs. 4, 66)
r Push [TRANSMIT] to set to the transmit condition.
t Set 3.55 MHz and key down.
y Set 3.80 MHz and key down.
u Push [TRANSMIT] to return to the receive condition.
89
10
ANTENNA TUNER OPERATION
90
10
ANTENNA TUNER OPERATION
10
Optional external tuner operation
AH-4/AH-3 HF AUTOMATIC ANTENNA
TUNER
The AH-4 matches the IC-756PROIII to a long wire
antenna more than 7 m/23 ft long (3.5 MHz and above).
The AH-3 matches the IC-756PROIII to a long wire
antenna more than 3 m/10 ft long
(3.5 MHz and above)
or more than 12 m/40 ft long
(1.8 MHz and above).
See p. 18 for the transceiver and AH-4/AH-3 connection.
See the AH-4/AH-3 instruction manual for AH-4/AH-3 in-
stallation and antenna connection details.
AH-4/AH-3 setting example:
RDANGER: HIGH VOLTAGE!
NEVER touch the antenna element while tuning
or transmitting.
NEVER operate the AH-4/AH-3 without an antenna
wire. The tuner and transceiver will be damaged.
NEVER operate the AH-4/AH-3 when it is not
grounded.
Transmitting before tuning may damage the trans-
ceiver. Note that the AH-4/AH-3 cannot tune when
using a
1
2
λ long wire or multiple of the operating fre-
quency.
When connecting the AH-4/AH-3, the antenna
connector assignments are [ANT2] for the inter-
nal tuner and [ANT1] for the AH-4/AH-3. The an-
tenna indicator in the LCD displays “ANT1(EXT)”
when the AH-4/AH-3 is connected and selected.
The AH-3 can be used for HF bands only. It can-
not be used for the 50 MHz band.
AH-4/AH-3 operation
Tuning is required for each frequency. Be sure to
re-tune the antenna before transmitting when you
change the frequency—even slightly.
q Set the desired frequency in an HF or 50 MHz
band for use with the AH-4. Set the desired fre-
quency in an HF band for use with the AH-3.
The AH-4/AH-3 will not operate on frequencies outside
of ham bands.
w Push [TUNER] for 1 sec.
The [TUNER] light blinks while tuning.
e The [TUNER] light lights constantly when tuning is
complete.
When the connected wire cannot be tuned, the
[TUNER] light goes out and the AH-4/AH-3 is by-
passed. At that point the antenna wire connection is to
the transceiver directly, and not via the AH-4/AH-3 an-
tenna tuner.
r
To bypass the AH-4/AH-3 manually, push
[TUNER].
[TUNER]
For mobile operation
For outdoor operation
Long wire
IC-756PROIII
Optional AH-2b
antenna element
ANTENNA TUNER OF THE IC-PW1
When using an external antenna tuner such as the
IC-PW1’s tuner, tune with the external antenna tuner,
while the internal tuner is turned OFF. After tuning is
completed, turn the internal tuner ON. Otherwise,
both tuners tune simultaneously and correct tuning
may not be obtained.
See the instruction manual included with each an-
tenna tuner for their respective operations.
CCLLOOCCKK22 OOffffsseett
This item sets the desired off-set time period for the
clock 2 indication within –24:00 to +24:00 in 5 min.
steps.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to set the default value.
00::0000
(default)
++ 99::0000
Rotate the tuning dial to set
the time.
Time set mode
The transceiver has a built-in 24-hour clock with
power-off and power-on timer functions. This is useful
when logging QSO’s and so on. The clock indication is
always displayed except after pushing [(F-INP)ENT].
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. to select the set mode
menu screen.
e Push [(F-4)TIME] to enter the time set mode.
r Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the desired
item.
t Rotate the tuning dial to set or select the desired
value or condition.
y Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the time set mode.
[(F-4)SET][(F-2)Z] [EXIT/SET][(F-1)Y]
TTiimmee ((NNooww))
This item sets the current time for the built-in 24-hour
clock.
1155::0000
Push [(F-4)SET] to enter the time.
TTiimmeerr FFuunnccttiioonn
This item sets the timer functions ON and OFF.
When the power-ON timer or the power-OFF timer is
used, “ON” must be selected in this item.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to set the default value.
OONN
The timer functions can be
operated. (default)
OOFFFF
The timer functions cannot
be operated.
CCLLOOCCKK22 FFuunnccttiioonn
This item turns the clock 2 indication ON and OFF.
The clock 2 is convenient to indicate the UTC or other
country’s local time, etc.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to set the default value.
OONN
The clock 2 is displayed
below the local time.
(default)
OOFFFF
The clock 2 does not dis-
play.
PPoowweerr--OOFFFF ppeerriioodd
This item sets the power-off period for automatic shut-
down after the power-on timer has turned power ON.
6600mmiinn
Push [(F-4)SET] to enter the time.
PPoowweerr--OONN TTiimmeerr sseett
This item sets the power-on time.
1155::0000
Push [(F-4)SET] to enter the time.
11
91
CLOCK AND TIMERS
92
11
CLOCK AND TIMERS
DSetting the current time
DClock2 function activity
DClock2 offset setting
DTimer function activity
q Entering time set mode, push [(F-1)
YY
] to select
the Time (Now) item.
w Set the current time using the tuning dial.
“TIME–set Push [SET]” blinks.
e Push [(F-4)SET] to enter the set time.
Push [EXIT/SET] to cancel the setting.
r Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit time set mode.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
qr.qot.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
Po
qt:wr
15:24
Set time appears.
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
TIME-setTIME-setPushPush [SET][SET]
SETSET
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 12:0012:00
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
ANTANT
1
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ATTATT
OFFOFF
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
qw:pp
12:00
q Entering time set mode, push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
]
to select the CLOCK2 Function item.
w Select the timer function activity using the tuning
dial.
e Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit time set mode.
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
COMPCOMP
OFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
DEF
q Entering time set mode, push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
]
to select the CLOCK2 Offset item.
w Rotate the tuning dial to set the offset time within
–24:00 to +24:00 in 5min. steps.
e Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit time set mode.
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
DEF
The timer functions can be switched ON and OFF
q Entering time set mode, push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
]
to select the Timer Function item.
w Select the timer function activity using the tuning
dial.
ON : Activates the timer functions when [POWER]
is pushed momentarily. (default)
OFF : Deactivates the timer functions even when
[POWER] is pushed momentarily.
e Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit time set mode.
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction OFFOFF
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 19:3019:30
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
DEF
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
DEF
11
93
11
CLOCK AND TIMERS
The transceiver can be set to turn OFF automatically
after being activated via the power-on timer. The
power-off period can be set to 5–120 min. in 5 min.
steps.
q Entering time set mode, push [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select
the Power-OFF Period item.
w Set the desired power-off time using the tuning
dial.
“TIMER – set Push [SET]” blinks.
e Push [(F-4)SET] to enter the set time.
Push [EXIT/SET] to cancel the setting.
r Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit timer set mode.
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
SETSET
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 19:3019:30
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 45min45min
TIMER-setTIMER-setPushPush [SET][SET]
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 19:3019:30
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
q Preset the power-on time and power-off period as
described previously.
w Push [POWER] momentarily to turn the timer func-
tion ON.
The [POWER] light lights when the timer function is
ON.
e Push [POWER] for 1 sec. to turn the power OFF.
The [POWER] light lights continuously.
r When the set time arrives, the power is automati-
cally turned ON.
t The transceiver emits 10 beeps and turns OFF
after the power-off period elapses.
The [POWER] light blinks while beeping.
Push [POWER] momentarily to cancel the power-off
timer, if desired.
The timer function in time set mode must be turned
ON to enable the timer operation. See above for
details.
[POWER]
The transceiver can be set to turn ON automatically at
a specified time.
q Entering time set mode, push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
]
to select the Power-ON Time Set item.
w Set the desired power-on time using the tuning
dial.
“TIMER–set Push [SET]” blinks.
e Push [(F-4)SET] to enter the set time.
Push [EXIT/SET] to cancel the setting.
r Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit time set mode.
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 19:3019:30
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
TIMER-setTIMER-setPushPush [SET][SET]
SETSET
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
TIME SETTIME SET
é
è
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 15:2415:24
CLOCK2CLOCK2FunctionFunction ONON
CLOCK2CLOCK2OffsetOffset 0:000:00
TimerTimer FunctionFunction ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
DSetting power-on time
DSetting power-off period
DTimer operation
12
94
SET MODE
Set mode description
Set mode is used for programming infrequently
changed values or conditions of functions. This trans-
ceiver has a level set mode, display set mode, timer
set mode and miscellaneous (others) set mode.
Set mode operation
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. to select the set mode
menu screen.
e Push [(F-1)LEVEL], [(F-2)DISP], [(F-3)DSP], [(F-
4)TIME] or [(F-5)OTHERS] to enter the desired set
mode.
r For level, display or miscellaneous (others) set
mode, push [(F-5)WIDE] to toggle wide and normal
screen.
t Push [(F-1)
YY
] or [(F-2)
ZZ
] to select the desired
item.
y Set the desired condition using the tuning dial.
Push [(F-3)DEF] for 1 sec. to select a default condition
or value.
u Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the set mode.
[(F-3)][(F-1)] [EXIT/SET] Tuning dial
[(F-2)] [(F-4)] [(F-5)]
• Display set mode (p. 97)
• Level set mode (p. 95)
• Start up screen
• Set mode menu screen
• DSP set mode (p. 99)
• Time set mode (p. 91)
• Miscellaneous (others) set mode (p. 99)
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
14.100.0014.100.00
1
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
USBUSB
14.100.0014.100.00
1
SET MODESET MODE
LEVEL LEVEL
SETSET
SSB Tx Tone (Bass)SSB Tx Tone (Bass) 0
SSB Tx Tone (Treble)SSB Tx Tone (Treble) 0
SSB TBW (WIDE)SSB TBW (WIDE) L 100100
SSB TBW (WIDE)SSB TBW (WIDE) H 29002900
SSB TBW (MID)SSB TBW (MID) L 300300
SSB TBW (MID)SSB TBW (MID) H 27002700
SSB TBW (NAR)SSB TBW (NAR) L 500500
OTHERS OTHERS
SETSET
TIME TIME
SETSET
DISPLAY DISPLAY
SETSET
SCOPESCOPE
VOICEVOICE KEYERKEYER
MEMORYMEMORY
SCANSCAN
LEVELLEVEL
DISPDISP DSPDSP
TIMETIME
OTHERSOTHERS
é
è
DEFDEF
é
è
DEFDEF
WIDEWIDE
é
è
DEFDEF
WIDEWIDE
SSB-FILSSB-FIL
CW-FILCW-FIL
é
è
DSP FILTER SETDSP FILTER SET
SHARPSHARPSSBSSB
SHARPCW
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
0FF0FF
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ANTANT
1
EXIT/SET
Push
for 1 sec.
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
CWCW
TXTX
VFOVFO
USBUSB
USBUSB
FIL2FIL2
qr.qot.pp
qr.wpt.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
METERMETER
PoPo
P.AMPP.AMP
1
ATTATT
0FF0FF
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
ANTANT
1
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
AGCAGC
MIDMID
F-1
F-2
F-3
F-4
F5
qw:pp
12:0012:00
qw:pp
12:0012:00
SET MODE MENUSET MODE MENU
LEVEL LEVEL TX Tone,Monitor,Side Tone etcTX Tone,Monitor,Side Tone etc
DISP Bright,Contrast,Style,Font etc DISP Bright,Contrast,Style,Font etc
DSP DSP DSP Filter TypeDSP Filter Type
TIME Clock/Timer TIME Clock/Timer
OTHERS OTHERS Other Set ModeOther Set Mode
CalibrationCalibration MarkerMarker OFFOFF
Beep(Confirmation)Beep(Confirmation) ONON
Beep(BandBeep(BandEdge)Edge) ONON
RF/SQLRF/SQLControlControl RF+SQLRF+SQL
QuickQuick DualwatchDualwatch ONON
QuickQuick SPRITSPRIT ONON
FMFMSPLITSPLITOffset(HF)Offset(HF) -0.100MHz-0.100MHz
TimeTime(Now)(Now) 12:0012:00
CLOCK2 FunctionCLOCK2 Function ONON
CLOCK2 OffsetCLOCK2 Offset 0:000:00
Timer FunctionTimer Function ONON
Power-ONPower-ON TimerTimer SetSet 0:000:00
Power-OFFPower-OFFPeriodPeriod 60min60min
Contrast(LCD) 60%
Bright(LCD) 50%
Horizon 4
Backlight(Switches) 8
DisplayType A
DisplayFont Basic1
MemoryName ON
12
95
12
SET MODE
Level set mode
SSSSBB TTxx TToonnee ((BBaassss))
This item adjusts the bass level of the transmit audio
tone in SSB mode from –5 dB to +5 dB in 1 dB steps.
0dB
0 dB (default)
SSSSBB TTxx TToonnee ((TTrreebbllee))
This item adjusts the treble level of the transmit audio
tone in SSB mode from –5 dB to +5 dB in 1 dB steps.
0dB
0 dB (default)
SSSSBB TTBBWW ((WWIIDDEE)) LL
These items set the transmission passband width for
wide setting by selecting the lower and higher fre-
quencies.
Lower freq. : 100 (default), 300 and 500 Hz
100
100 Hz (default)
SSSSBB TTBBWW ((WWIIDDEE)) HH
These items set the transmission passband width for
wide setting by selecting the lower and higher fre-
quencies.
Higher freq.: 2500, 2700 and 2900 Hz (default)
2900
2900 Hz (default)
SSSSBB TTBBWW ((MMIIDD)) LL
These items set the transmission passband width for
middle setting by selecting the lower and higher fre-
quencies.
Lower freq. : 100, 300 (default) and 500 Hz
300
300 Hz (default)
SSSSBB TTBBWW ((MMIIDD)) HH
These items set the transmission passband width for
middle setting by selecting the lower and higher fre-
quencies.
Higher freq.: 2500, 2700 (default) and 2900 Hz
2700
2700 Hz (default)
SSSSBB TTBBWW ((NNAARR)) LL
These items set the transmission passband width for
narrow setting by selecting the lower and higher fre-
quencies.
Lower freq. : 100, 300 and 500 Hz (default)
500
500 Hz (default)
96
12
SET MODE
Level set mode (continued)
SSSSBB TTBBWW ((NNAARR)) HH
These items set the transmission passband width for
narrow setting by selecting the lower and higher fre-
quencies.
Lower freq. : 2500 (default), 2700 and 2900 Hz
2500
2500 Hz (default)
MMoonniittoorr LLeevveell
This item adjusts the transmit IF signal monitor level
from 0% to 100% in 1% steps.
See p. 70 for details.
50%
50% (default)
SSiiddee TToonnee LLeevveell
This item adjusts the CW side tone level from 0% to
100% in 1% steps.
See p. 70 for details.
50%
50% (default)
BBeeeepp LLeevveell
This item adjusts the volume level for confirmation
beep tones from 0% to 100% in 1% steps. When
beep tones are turned OFF, this setting has no effect.
50%
50% (default)
BBeeeepp LLeevveell LLiimmiitt
This item allows you to set a maximum volume level
for confirmation beep tones. Confirmation beep tones
are linked to the [AF] control until a specified volume
level is reachedfurther rotation of the [AF] control
will not increase the volume of the beep tones.
OONN
Beep level is limited with
[AF] (default)
OOFFFF
Beep level is linked to [AF]
SSiiddee TToonnee LLeevveell LLiimmiitt
This item allows you to set a maximum volume level
for CW side tones. CW side tones are linked to the
[AF] control until a specified volume level is reached
—further rotation of the [AF] control will not increase
the volume of the CW side tones.
OONN
CW side tone level is limited
with [AF] (default)
OOFFFF
CW side tone level is linked
to [AF]
12
97
12
SET MODE
Display set mode
To adjust the LCD contrast or backlight, wait until
the LCD becomes stable (10 min. or more after turn-
ing power ON). This is an inherent characteristic of
LCDs and LCD backlights and does not indicate a
transceiver malfunction.
CCoonnttrraasstt ((LLCCDD))
This item adjusts the contrast of the LCD from 0% to
100% in 1% steps.
60%
60% (default)
BBaacckklliigghhtt ((LLCCDD))
This item adjusts the brightness of the LCD from 0%
to 100% in 1% steps.
50%
50% (default)
HHoorriizzoonn
This item adjusts the horizontal position of the LCD
from 1 to 8.
5
Horizontal position is 5. (default)
BBaacckklliigghhtt((SSwwiittcchheess))
This item adjusts the brightness of the switches from
1 to 8.
8
Backlight level is 8. (Maximum; default)
DDiissppllaayy TTyyppee
This item sets the LCD screen type. There are 8 se-
lectable types: A, B, C, D, E, F, G and H.
AA
A-type LCD screen (default)
DDiissppllaayy FFoonntt
This item sets the font of the frequency readouts.
There are 7 selectable fonts: Basic1, Basic2, Pop,
7seg (7 segment numeral), Italic 1, Italic 2 and Clas-
sic.
IIttaalliicc22
Italic 2 font (default)
MMeemmoorryy NNaammee
This item sets the memory name indication ON and
OFF.
See p. 81 for details.
OONN
Memory name is displayed.
(default)
OOFFFF
Memory name is not dis-
played.
98
12
SET MODE
SSccrreeeenn SSaavveerr FFuunnccttiioonn
This item sets the screen saver setting from 60 min,
30 min, 15 min and OFF.
6600 mmiinn
Screen saver function activates after 60 minute of inactivity.
(default)
3300 mmiinn
Screen saver function activates after 30 minute of inactivity.
1155 mmiinn
Screen saver function activates after 15 minute of inactivity.
OOFFFF
Screen saver function is OFF.
MMyy CCaallll
Your call sign, etc. can be displayed in the opening
screen when turning power ON. Up to 10 characters
can be programmed.
Capital letters, numerals, some symbols (– /
.
) and
spaces can be used.
q Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
w Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. then [(F-2)DISP] mo-
mentarily to select the display set mode screen.
e Push [(F-2)
ZZ
] several times to select the ‘My Call’
item.
r Push [(F-4)EDIT] to edit.
•Acursor appears and blinks.
t Input the desired character by rotating the tuning
dial or by pushing the band key for number input.
Push [ABC] to select capital letters.
Push [123] or [etc] to toggle numerals and symbols.
Push [(F-1)
] or [(F-2)
] for cursor movement.
Push [(F-3)DEL] to delete the selected character.
Push [(F-4)SPACE] to input a space.
y Push [EXIT/SET] to input the set name.
The cursor disappears.
u Push [EXIT/SET] to exit the set mode screen.
Opening screen example
ja3yua
NOW CALIBRATING
DIGITAL SIGNAL PROCESSOR
PLEASE WAIT FOR 10sec.
ç
å
DELDEL
SPACESPACE WIDEWIDE
DISPLAY SET
123123
ABCABC
Character
group
keys
Selected
character
Bright(LCD) 50%
Horizon 4
Backlight(Switches) 8
DisplayType A
DisplayFont Basic1
MemoryName ON
MyCall _A3YUA
ABCABC
é
è
EDIT
WIDEWIDE
DISPLAY SET
VOXVOX
OFFOFF
COMPCOMP
OFFOFF
WIDEWIDE
AGCAGC
MIDMID
Bright(LCD) 50%
Horizon 4
Backlight(Switches) 8
DisplayType A
DisplayFont Basic1
MemoryName ON
MyCall JA3YUA
Display set mode (continued)
12
99
12
SET MODE
Miscellaneous (others) set mode
CCaalliibbrraattiioonn MMaarrkkeerr
This item is used for a simple frequency check of the
transceiver.
See p. 109 for calibration procedure.
Turn the calibration marker OFF after checking the
frequency of the transceiver.
OONN
Calibration marker ON
OOFFFF
Calibration marker OFF
(default)
BBeeeepp((CCoonnffiirrmmaattiioonn))
A beep sounds each time a switch is pushed to con-
firm it. This function can be turned OFF for silent op-
eration.
The volume level can be set in level set mode. (p. 96)
OONN
Confirmation beep ON
(default)
OOFFFF
Confirmation beep OFF
BBeeeepp((BBaanndd EEddggee))
A beep sounds when an operating frequency enters
or exits an amateur band. This functions independent
of the confirmation beep setting (above).
The volume level can be set in level set mode. (p. 96)
OONN
Band edge beep ON
(default)
OOFFFF
Band edge beep OFF
RRFF//SSQQLL CCoonnttrrooll
The [RF/SQL] control can be set as the RF/squelch
control (default), the squelch control only (RF gain is
fixed at maximum) or ‘Auto’ (RF gain control in SSB,
CW and RTTY; squelch control in AM and FM).
See pgs. 2, 30 for details.
RRFF++SSQQLL
[RF/SQL] control as RF/squelch control
(default)
SSQQLL
[RF/SQL] control as squelch control
AAUUTTOO
[RF/SQL] control as RF gain control in SSB,
CW and RTTY; squelch control in AM and
FM
DSP filter set mode
To suit your operating style, the type of DSP filter
shape for SSB and CW can be selected.
q Push the [EXIT/SET] several times to close a
multi-function screen, if necessary.
w Push the [EXIT/SET] switch for 1 sec. to enter set
mode.
e Push the [(F-3)DSP] switch to enter the DSP filter
set mode.
r Push one of [(F-2)SSB-FIL] or [(F-4)CW-FIL] to
select the desired DSP filter shape from sharp and
soft for SSB or CW mode, respectively.
t Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit the DSP filter set
mode.
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
DSP FILTER SET
SSBSSB
SHARPSHARP CWCW
SHARPSHARP
SSB-FILSSB-FIL CW-FILCW-FIL
SSBSSB
SOFTSOFT CWCW SOFTSOFT
F-4
Push
F-2
Push
100
12
SET MODE
QQuuiicckk DDuuaallwwaattcchh
When this item is set to ON, pushing [DUALWATCH]
for 1 sec. sets the sub readout frequency to the main
readout frequency and activates dualwatch operation.
See p. 63 for details.
OONN
Quick dualwatch ON
(default)
OOFFFF
Quick dualwatch OFF
QQuuiicckk SSPPLLIITT
When this item is set to ON, pushing [SPLIT] for 1
sec. sets the sub readout frequency to the main read-
out frequency and activates split operation.
See p. 72 for details.
OONN
Quick split ON
(default)
OOFFFF
Quick split OFF
Miscellaneous (others) set mode (continued)
FFMM SSPPLLIITT OOffffsseett((5500MM))
This item sets the offset (difference between transmit
and receive frequencies) for the quick split function.
However, this setting is used for 50 MHz band FM
mode only, and is used to input the repeater offset for
the 50 MHz band.
The offset frequency can be set from –4 MHz to
+4 MHz in 1 kHz steps.
--00..550000MMHHzz
Minus 0.5 MHz offset
(default)
++44..000000MMHHzz
Plus 4.0 MHz offset
SSPPLLIITT LLOOCCKK
When this item is ON, the tuning dial can be used to
adjust the transmit frequency while pushing [XFC]
even while the lock function is activated.
See p. 71 for split frequency operation details.
OONN
Split lock function ON
OOFFFF
Split lock function OFF
(default)
FFMM SSPPLLIITT OOffffsseett((HHFF))
This item sets the offset (difference between transmit
and receive frequencies) for the quick split function.
However, this setting is used for HF bands in FM
mode only and is used to input the repeater offset for
an HF band.
The offset frequency can be set from –4 MHz to
+4 MHz in 1 kHz steps.
--00..110000MMHHzz
Minus 0.1 MHz offset
(default)
--44..000000MMHHzz
Minus 4.0 MHz offset
12
101
12
SET MODE
Miscellaneous (others) set mode (continued)
RRTTTTYY MMaarrkk FFrreeqquueennccyy
This item selects the RTTY mark frequency. RTTY
mark frequency is switched between 1275, 1615 and
2125 Hz.
22112255
2125 Hz RTTY mark
frequency (default)
11227755
1275 Hz RTTY mark
frequency
RRTTTTYY SShhiifftt WWiiddtthh
This item adjusts the RTTY shift width. There are 3
selectable values: 170, 200 and 425 Hz.
117700
170 Hz RTTY shift
frequency (default)
442255
425 Hz RTTY shift
frequency
RRTTTTYY KKeeyyiinngg PPoollaarriittyy
This item selects the RTTY keying polarity. Normal or
reverse keying polarity can be selected.
When reverse polarity is selected, Mark and Space
are reversed.
- Normal : Key open/close = Mark/Space
- Reverse : Key open/close = Space/Mark
NNoorrmmaall
Normal polarity (default)
RReevveerrssee
Reverse polarity
[[AANNTT]] SSwwiittcchh
You can set the antenna connector selection to auto-
matic, manual or non-selection (when using 1 an-
tenna only).
When “Auto” is selected, the antenna switch is acti-
vated and the band memory memorizes the selected
antenna. See p. 88 for details.
When “Manual” is selected, the antenna switch is ac-
tivated and selects an antenna manually.
When “OFF” is selected, the antenna switch is not ac-
tivated and does not function. The [ANT1] connector
is always selected in this case.
AAuuttoo
Antenna switch is activated and the
selection is automatically memorized.
(default)
MMaannuuaall
Antenna switch is activated.
OOFFFF
Antenna switch is deactivated and
[ANT1] is always selected.
TTuunneerr ((AAuuttoo SSttaarrtt))
The internal antenna tuner has an automatic start ca-
pability which starts tuning if the SWR is higher than
1.5–3:1.
When “OFF” is selected, the tuner remains OFF even
when the SWR is poor (1.5–3:1). When “ON” is se-
lected, automatic tune starts even when the tuner is
turned OFF.
OONN
Automatic tuner start
ON
OOFFFF
Automatic tuner start
OFF (default)
TTuunneerr ((PPTTTT SSttaarrtt))
Tuning of the internal antenna tuner can be started
automatically at the moment the PTT is pushed after
the operating frequency is changed (more than 1%
from last-tuned frequency).
OONN
Automatic PTT start
ON
OOFFFF
Automatic PTT start
OFF (default)
102
12
SET MODE
Miscellaneous (others) set mode (continued)
SSPPEEEECCHH LLaanngguuaaggee
When the optional UT-102
VOICE SYNTHESIZER UNIT
is
installed, you can select between English and Japan-
ese as the language.
See p. 105 for unit installation.
EEnngglliisshh
English announcement
(default)
JJaappaanneessee
Japanese announcement
SSPPEEEECCHH SSppeeeedd
When the optional UT-102
VOICE SYNTHESIZER UNIT
is
installed, you can select between faster or slower
synthesizer output.
See p. 105 for unit installation.
HHIIGGHH
Faster announcement
(default)
LLOOWW
Slower announcement
SSPPEEEECCHH SS--LLeevveell
When the optional UT-102
VOICE SYNTHESIZER UNIT
is
installed, you can have frequency, mode and signal
level announcement. Signal level announcement can
be deactivated if desired.
When “OFF” is selected, the signal level is not an-
nounced.
See p. 105 for unit installation.
OONN
Signal level announcement
(default)
OOFFFF
No signal level
announcement
MMeemmooppaadd NNuummbbeerrss
This item sets the number of memo pad channels
available. 5 or 10 memo pads can be set.
55
5 memo pads
(default)
1100
10 memo pads
12
103
12
SET MODE
Miscellaneous (others) set mode (continued)
MMAAIINN DDIIAALL AAuuttoo TTSS
This item sets the auto tuning step function. When ro-
tating the tuning dial rapidly, the tuning step automat-
ically changes several times as selected.
There are 2 type of auto tuning steps: HIGH (Fastest)
and LOW (Faster).
HHIIGGHH
Auto tuning step is turned ON.
Fastest tuning step during rapid rotation
(default)
LLOOWW
Auto tuning step is turned ON.
Faster tuning step during rapid rotation
OOFFFF
Auto tuning step is turned OFF.
SSSSBB//CCWW SSyynncchhrroonnoouuss TTuunniinngg
This item selects the displayed frequency shift func-
tion from ON and OFF.
When this function is activated, the receiving signal
can be kept to receive even when the operating mode
is changed between SSB and CW.
The frequency shifting value may differ according
to the CW pitch setting.
OONN
The displayed frequency
shifts when the operating
mode is changed between
SSB and CW.
OOFFFF
The displayed frequency
does not shift.
(default)
CCWW NNoorrmmaall SSiiddee
Selects the carrier point of CW mode from LSB and
USB.
LLSSBB
The carrier point is set to
LSB side.
(default)
UUSSBB
The carrier point is set to
USB side.
MMIICC UUpp//DDoowwnn SSppeeeedd
This item sets the rate at which frequencies are
scanned when the microphone [UP]/[DN] switches
are pushed and held. High or low can be selected.
HHIIGGHH
High speed (default,
50 tuning steps/sec.)
LLOOWW
Low speed
(25 tuning steps/sec.)
QQuuiicckk RRIITT//TTXX CClleeaarr
This item selects the RIT/TX frequency clearing in-
struction with the [CLEAR] switch.
OONN
Clears the RIT/TX fre-
quency when [CLEAR] is
pushed momentarily.
OOFFFF
Clears the RIT/TX fre-
quency when [CLEAR] is
pushed for 1 sec.
(default)
104
12
SET MODE
Miscellaneous (others) set mode (continued)
EExxtteerrnnaall KKeeyyppaadd
This item sets the external keypad capability and
function.
For your information
The following diagram shows the equivalent circuit of
an external keypad and connects to the pin 3 and
pin 7 of the [MIC] connector (p. 18).
AAuuttoo
Pushing one of external keypad
switches, transmits the desired voice
memory during a phone mode (SSB,
AM or FM), or memory keyer contents
during CW mode operation.
VVOOIICCEE PPLLAAYY((TTXX))
Pushing one of external keypad
switches, transmits the desired voice
memory contents during a phone
mode operation.
KKEEYYEERR SSEENNDD
Pushing one of external keypad
switches, transmits the desired keyer
memory contents during CW mode
operation.
OOFFFF
External keypad does not function.
(default)
To [MIC] connector pin e
To [MIC] connector pin u
1.5k
±
5%
1.5k
±
5%
2.2k
±
5%
4.7k
±
5%
S1
(T1/M1)
S2
(T2/M2)
S3
(T3/M3)
S4
(T4/M4)
USER EXTERNAL KEYPAD
CCII--VV BBaauudd RRaattee
This item sets the data transfer rate. 300, 1200, 4800,
9600, 19200 bps and “Auto” are available.
When “Auto” is selected, the baud rate is automati-
cally set according to the connected controller or re-
mote controller.
AAuuttoo
Auto baud rate
(default)
1199220000
19200 bps
CCII--VV AAddddrreessss
To distinguish equipment, each CI-V transceiver has
its own Icom standard address in hexadecimal code.
The IC-756PROIII’s address is 6Eh.
When 2 or more IC-756PROIII’s are connected to an
optional CT-17
CI
-
V LEVEL CONVERTER
, rotate the tun-
ing dial to select a different address for each IC-
756PROIII in the range 01h to 7Fh.
66EEhh
Address of 6Eh
(default)
77FFhh
Address of 7Fh
CCII--VV TTrraannsscceeiivvee
Transceive operation is possible with the
IC-756PROIII
connected to other Icom HF transceivers or receivers.
When “ON” is selected, changing the frequency, op-
erating mode, etc. on the IC-756PROIII automatically
changes those of connected transceivers (or re-
ceivers) and vice versa.
OONN
Transceive ON
(default)
OOFFFF
Transceive OFF
CCII--VV wwiitthh IICC--773311
When connecting the IC-756PROIII to the IC-735 for
transceive operation, you must change the operating
frequency data length to 4 bytes.
This item must be set to “ON” only when operating the
transceiver with the IC-735.
OONN
4 bytes of frequency data
OOFFFF
5 bytes of frequency data
(default)
12
13
105
OPTION INSTALLATION
Follow the case and cover opening procedures shown
here when you want to install an optional unit or adjust
the internal units, etc.
CAUTION: DISCONNECT the DC power cable
from the transceiver before performing any work on
the transceiver. Otherwise, there is danger of elec-
tric shock and/or equipment damage.
Opening the transceivers cases
The UT-102 announces the accessed readout’s fre-
quency, mode, etc. (S-meter level can also be an-
nounced—p. 102) in a clear, electronically-generated
voice, in English (or Japanese).
Push [LOCK/SPEECH] for 1 sec. to announce the
frequency, etc.
q Remove the top and bottom covers as shown
above.
w Remove the protective paper attached to the bot-
tom of the UT-102 to expose the adhesive strip.
e Plug UT-102 into J3502 on the MAIN unit as
shown in the diagram at right.
r Adjust the trimmer SPCH to set the speech level if
desired. Refer to inside views on p. 106.
t Return the top and bottom covers to their original
positions.
U
T
-1
0
2
J3502
UT-102
MAIN
unit
UT-102
VOICE SYNTHESIZER UNIT
q Remove 2 screws from the left side of the trans-
ceiver to remove the carrying handle as shown
below.
w Remove 7 screws from the top of the transceiver
and 4 screws from the sides, then lift up the top
cover.
e Turn the transceiver upside down.
r Remove 6 screws from the bottom of the trans-
ceiver, then lift up the bottom cover.
14
106
INTERNAL VIEWS
PA fuse (FGB 5 A)
PA unit
FILTER unit
Internal antenna
tuner
•Top view
BPF unit
PRE AMP unit
RF unit
PLL unit
Space for optional
voice synthesizer
(UT-102)
MAIN unit
Clock backup battery
DSP unit
SPCH
Optional voice
synthesizer level adj.
Bottom view
13
14
15
107
MAINTENANCE
SCAN
Troubleshooting
The following chart is designed to help you correct
problems which are not equipment malfunctions.
If you are unable to locate the cause of a problem or
solve it through the use of this chart, contact your near-
est Icom Dealer or Service Center.
PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE SOLUTION REF.
RECEIVE POWERTRANSMIT
Power does not come on
when the [POWER] switch
is pushed.
No sounds come out from
the speaker.
Sensitivity is too low, and
only strong signals are au-
dible.
Received audio is unclear
or distorted.
The [ANT] switch does not
function.
Transmitting is impossible.
Output power is too low.
You can receive signals,
but no contact possible
with another station.
Transmit signal is unclear
or distorted.
Repeater cannot be ac-
cessed.
Programmed scan does
not stop.
Programmed scan does
not start.
Memory scan does not
start.
Select memory scan does
not start.
• Power cable is improperly connected.
• Fuse is blown.
•Volume level is too low.
• The squelch is closed.
• The transceiver is in transmitting condition.
• The antenna is not connected properly.
• The antenna for another band is selected.
• The antenna is not properly tuned.
• The attenuator is activated.
•Wrong operating mode is selected.
PBT function is activated.
Noise blanker is turned ON when receiving a
strong signal.
Preamp is activated.
The noise reduction is activated and the [NR]
control is too far clockwise.
The antenna switch has not been activated.
The operating frequency is not set to a ham
band.
[RF POWER] is set too far counterclockwise
[MIC GAIN] is set too far counterclockwise
The antenna for another band is selected.
The antenna is not properly tuned.
RIT or TX function is activated.
•Split frequency function and/or dualwatch are
activated.
[MIC GAIN] is set too far clockwise.
• The speech compressor function is activated.
• Split frequency function is not activated.
Programmed subaudible tone frequency is set
at wrong frequency.
Squelch is open.
[RF/SQL] is assigned to RF gain control and
squelch is open.
The same frequencies have been programmed
in scan edge memory channels P1 and P2.
•2 or more memory channels have not been
programmed.
•2 or more memory channels have not been
designated as select channels.
• Re-connect the DC power cable correctly.
• Check for the cause, then replace the fuse with
the spare one.
(Fuses are installed in the DC power cable and
the internal PA unit.)
• Rotate [AF] clockwise to obtain a suitable lis-
tening level.
•Turn [RF/SQL] to 10 o’clock position to open
the squelch.
Push [TRANSMIT] to receive or check the
SEND line of an external unit, if desired.
• Re-connect to the antenna connector.
Select an antenna suitable for the operating fre-
quency.
• Push [TUNER] for 1 sec. to manually tune the
antenna.
• Push [ATT] several times to select “ATT OFF.”
• Select a suitable operating mode.
Push [PBT CLR] for 1 sec. to reset the function.
• Push [NB] to turn the noise blanker OFF.
Push [P.AMP] once or twice to turn the function
OFF.
• Set the [NR] control for maximum readability.
Set the antenna switch in set mode to “Auto” or
“Manual.”
Set the frequency to a ham band.
Rotate [RF POWER] clockwise.
Set [MIC GAIN] to a suitable position.
Select an antenna suitable for the operating fre-
quency.
Push [TUNER] for 1 sec. to manually tune the
antenna.
Push [RIT] or [
TX] to turn the function OFF.
Push [SPLIT] and/or [DUALWATCH] to turn the
function OFF.
• Set [MIC GAIN] to a suitable position.
• Push [COMP] to turn the function OFF.
• Push [SPLIT] to turn the function ON
• Reset the frequency using set mode.
Set [RF/SQL] to the threshold point.
Reset [RF/SQL] control assignment and set it to
the threshold point.
•Program different frequencies in scan edge
memory channel P1 and P2.
Program more than 2 memory channels.
Designate more than 2 memory channels as se-
lect channels for the scan.
p. 16
p. 108
p. 1
p. 2
p. 1
pgs. 3,
88
p. 89
p. 3
p. 29
p. 60
p. 64
p. 3
p. 65
p. 88
p. 25
p. 2
p. 1
p. 3
p. 89
p. 6
pgs. 8,
63, 71
p. 1
p.68
p. 8
p. 52
p. 2
pgs. 2,
30, 99
p. 79
p. 79
pgs. 78,
86
108
15
MAINTENANCE
Fuse replacement
If a fuse blows or the transceiver stops functioning, try
to find the source of the problem, and replace the dam-
aged fuse with a new, rated fuse.
CAUTION:
DISCONNECT the DC power cable
from the transceiver when changing a fuse.
The IC-756PROIII has 2 types of fuses installed for
transceiver protection.
DC power cable fuses ................................FGB 30 A
Circuitry fuse ................................................FGB 5 A
DC POWER CABLE FUSE REPLACEMENT
30 A
fuse
Clock backup battery replacement
The transceiver has a lithium backup battery
(CR2032) inside for clock and timer functions. The
usual life of the backup battery is approximately 2
years.
When the backup battery is exhausted, the trans-
ceiver transmits and receives normally but cannot re-
tain the current time.
See p. 106 for battery location.
CIRCUITRY FUSE REPLACEMENT
The 13.8 V DC from the DC power cable is conver
ted to 5 V or 8 V and applied to all units in the IC-
756PROIII, except for the power amplifier, through
the circuitry fuse. This fuse is installed in the PA unit.
q Remove the top cover as shown on p. 105.
w Remove 11 screws from the PA shielding plate,
then remove the plate.
e Replace the circuitry fuse as shown in the diagram
below.
r Replace the PA shielding plate and top cover.
Circuitry fuse (FGB 5 A)
PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE SOLUTION REF.
DISPLAY
The displayed frequency
does not change properly.
The display indicates “IC-
756PROIII” only.
• The dial lock function is activated.
•Aset mode screen is selected.
The internal CPU has malfunctioned.
The screen saver function is activated.
•Push [LOCK/SPEECH] to turn the function OFF.
• Push [EXIT/SET] several times to exit the set
mode screen.
Reset the CPU.
Operate the transceiver.
Set the screen saver function in set mode to
“OFF.”
p. 65
pgs. 10,
94
p. 21
p. 98
15
109
15
MAINTENANCE
Tuning dial brake adjustment
The tension of the tuning dial may be adjusted to suit
your preference.
The brake adjustment screw is located on the right
side of the tuning dial. See the figure at right.
Turn the brake adjustment screw clockwise or coun-
terclockwise to obtain a comfortable tension level
while turning the dial continuously and evenly in one
direction.
Frequency calibration (approximate)
A very accurate frequency counter is required to cali-
brate the frequency of the transceiver. However, a
rough check may be performed by receiving radio
station WWV, or other standard frequency signals.
CAUTION: Your transceiver has been thor-
oughly adjusted and checked at the factory before
being shipped. You should not calibrate frequen-
cies, except for special reasons.
q Push [SSB] to select USB mode.
w Push [PBT CLR] for 1 sec. to clear the PBT set-
tings and make sure that the RIT/TX function is
not activated.
e Set the frequency to the standard frequency sta-
tion minus 1 kHz.
When receiving WWV (10.000.00 MHz) as a standard
frequency, set the operating frequency for
9.999.00 MHz.
Other standard frequencies can also be used.
r Push [EXIT/SET] several times to close a multi-
function screen, if necessary.
t Push [EXIT/SET] for 1 sec. to select the set mode
screen.
y Push [(F-5)OTHERS] to enter miscellaneous (oth-
ers) set mode.
u Push [(F-1)
YY
] several times to select the “Calibra-
tion marker” item.
i Rotate the tuning dial clockwise to turn the calibra-
tion marker ON.
Side tone may be heard.
o Adjust the calibration pot on the right side panel of
the transceiver for a zero beat with the received
standard signal as shown below.
Zero beat means that two signals are exactly the same
frequency, resulting in a single tone being emitted.
!0 Rotate the tuning dial counterclockwise to turn the
calibration marker OFF.
!1 Push [EXIT/SET] twice to exit set mode.
DEFDEF WIDEWIDE
é
è
AGCAGC
MIDMID
BK-INBK-IN
OFFOFF
1/41/4
OFFOFF
CalibrationCalibration MarkerMarker ONON
Beep(Confirmation)Beep(Confirmation) ONON
Beep(BandBeep(BandEdge)Edge) ONON
RF/SQLRF/SQLControlControl RF+SQLRF+SQL
QuickQuick DualwatchDualwatch ONON
QuickQuick SPRITSPRIT ONON
FMFMSPLITSPLITOffset(HF)Offset(HF) -0.100MHz-0.100MHz
OTHERSOTHERSSETSET
SFTSFT
0
FIL2FIL2
USBUSB
TXTX
USBUSB
o.ooo.pp
14.100.0014.100.00
1
VFOVFO
BWBW
2.4k2.4k
ANTANT
1
METERMETER
PoPo
qw:pp
qw:pp
16
110
CONTROL COMMAND
•CI-V connection example
The transceiver can be connected through an optional
CT-17 CI-V LEVEL CONVERTER to a personal computer
equipped with an RS-232C port. The Icom Communi-
cations Interface-V (CI-V) controls the following func-
tions of the transceiver.
Up to 4 Icom CI-V transceivers or transceivers can be
connected to a personal computer equipped with an
RS-232C port. See p. 104 for setting the CI-V condi-
tion using set mode.
•Data format
The CI-V system can be operated using the following
data formats. Data formats differ according to com-
mand numbers. A data area or sub command is added
for some commands.
Controller to IC-756PROIII
FE FE 6E E0 Cn Sc Data area FD
Preamble
code (fixed)
Transceiver’s
default address
Controller’s
default address
Command number
(see the command table)
Sub command number
(see command table)
BCD code data for
frequency or memory
number entry
End of message
code (fixed)
OK message to controller
FE FE E0 6E FB FD
FE FE E0 6E FA FD
Preamble
code (fixed)
Controller’s
default address
Transceiver’s
default address
OK code
(fixed)
End of message
code (fixed)
NG message to controller
NG code
(fixed)
IC-756PROIII to controller
qwert y u
FE FE E0 6E Cn Sc Data area FD
qwert y u
Remote jack (CI-V) information
9–15 V
DC
personal
computer
ct- 17
IC-756PROIII
mini-plug cable
15
16
Command table
00 Send frequency data
01 Same as Send mode data
command 06
02 Read band edge frequencies
03 Read operating frequency
04 Read operating mode
05 Set frequency data
06 00 Select LSB
01 Select USB
02 Select AM
03 Select CW
04 Select RTTY
05 Select FM
07 Select CW-R
08 Select RTTY-R
07 Select VFO mode
B0 Exchange main and sub readouts
B1 Equalize main and sub readouts
C0 Turn the dualwatch OFF
C1 Turn the dualwatch ON
D0 Select main readout
D1 Select sub readout
08 Select memory mode
0001–0101*
1
Select memory channel
*
1
P1=0100, P2=0101
09 Memory write
0A Memory to VFO
0B Memory clear
0E 00 Scan stop
01 Programmed/memory scan start
02 Programmed scan start
03 F scan start
12 Fine programmed scan start
13 Fine F scan start
22 Memory scan start
23 Select memory scan start
0E A1–A7 Set F scan span (A1=±5 kHz,
A2=±10 kHz, A3=±20 kHz,
A4=±50 kHz, A5=±100 kHz,
A6=±500 kHz, A7=±1 MHz)
B0 Set as non-select channel
B1 Set as select channel
D0 Set scan resume OFF
D3 Set scan resume ON
0F 00 Turn the split function OFF
01 Turn the split function ON
10 00 Select 10 Hz (1 Hz) tuning step
01 Select 100 Hz tuning step
02 Select 1 kHz tuning step
03 Select 5 kHz tuning step
04 Select 9 kHz tuning step
05 Select 10 kHz tuning step
06 Select 12.5 kHz tuning step
07 Select 20 kHz tuning step
08 Select 25 kHz tuning step
11 00 Attenuator OFF
06 Attenuator ON (6 dB)
12 Attenuator ON (12 dB)
18 Attenuator ON (18 dB)
12 00 Select/read antenna selection
01 (00=ANT1, 01=ANT2 : Add 0 or 1
to turn [RX ANT] OFF or ON, re-
spectively.)
13 00 Announce with voice synthesizer
01 (00=all data; 01=frequency and
02 S-meter level; 02=receive mode)
14 01 + Level data [AF] level setting (0=max. CCW to
255=max. CW)
02 + Level data [RF] level setting (0=max. CCW to
255=11 o’clock)
03 + Level data [SQL] level setting (0=11 o’clock to
255=max. CW)
06 + Level data [NR] level setting (0=min. to
255=max.)
07 + Level data Inside [TWIN PBT] setting or IF
shift setting (0=max. CCW,
128=center, 255=max. CW)
08 + Level data Outside [TWIN PBT] setting
(0=max. CCW, 128=center,
255=max. CW)
09 + Level data [CW PITCH] setting (0=low pitch
to 255=high pitch)
0A + Level data [RF POWER] setting (0=mini. to
255=max.)
0B + Level data [MIC GAIN] setting (0=mini. to
255=max.)
0C + Level data [KEY SPEED] setting (0=slow to
255=fast)
0D + Level data [NOTCH] setting (0=low freq. to
255=high freq.)
0E + Level data [COMP] setting (0=mini. to
255=max.)
0F + Level data [BK-IN DELAY] setting (0=short
delay to 255=long delay)
10 + Level data [BAL] level setting (0=max. CCW,
128=center, 255=max. CW)
12 + Level data [NB] level setting (0=mini. to
255=max.)
15 + Level data Monitor gain setting (0=0% to
255=100%)
16 + Level data VOX gain setting (0=0% to
255=100%)
17 + Level data Anti-VOX gain setting (0=0% to
255=100%)
18 + Level data LCD contrast setting (0=0% to
255=100%)
19 + Level data LCD bright setting (0=0% to
255=100%)
15 01 Read squelch condition
02 Read S-meter level
11 Read Po meter level
12 Read SWR meter level
13 Read ALC meter level
14 Read COMP meter level
16 02 Preamp (0=OFF; 1=preamp 1;
2=preamp 2)
12 AGC selection (1=Fast; 2=Mid;
3=Slow)
Command Sub command Description Command Sub command Description
111
16
CONTROL COMMAND
112
16
CONTROL COMMAND
•Command table (continued)
1A 0517 Send/read power-ON timer set
(0000 to 2359)
0518 Send/read power-OFF period
(5=5 min. to 120=120 min. in
5min. step)
0519 Send/read calibration marker
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0520 Send/read confirmation beep
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0521 Send/read band edge beep
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0522 Send/read RF/SQL control set
(0=Auto, 1=SQL, 2=RF+SQL)
0523 Send/read quick dualwatch set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0524 Send/read quick split set (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0525 Send/read FM split offset (HF)
–4.000 to +4.000 MHz
(see p. 114 for details)
0526 Send/read FM split offset (50 MHz)
–4.000 to +4.000 MHz
(see p. 114 for details)
0527 Send/read split lock set (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0528 Send/read tuner auto start set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0529 Send/read PTT tune set (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0530 Send/read antenna selection
(0=OFF, 1=Manual, 2=Auto)
0531 Send/read RTTY mark frequency
(0=1275 Hz, 1=1615 Hz,
2=2125 Hz)
0532 Send/read RTTY shift width
(0=170 Hz, 1=200 Hz, 2=425 Hz)
0533 Send/read RTTY keying polarity
(0=Normal, 1=Reverse)
0534 Send/read RTTY decode USOS
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0535 Send/read RTTY decode new line
code (0=CR,LF,CR+LF,
1=CR+LF)
0536 Send/read speech language
(0=English, 1=Japanese)
0537 Send/read speech speed (0=slow,
1=fast)
0538 Send/read S-level speech (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0539 Send/read memo pad numbers
(0=5 ch, 1=10 ch)
0540 Send/read main dial auto TS
(0=OFF, 1=Low, 2=High)
0541 Send/read mic. up/down speed
(0=Low, 1=High)
0542 Send/read CI-V transceive set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0543 Send/read CI-V 731 mode set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
16 22 Noise blanker (0=OFF; 1=ON)
40 Noise reduction (0=OFF; 1=ON)
41 Auto notch (0=OFF; 1=ON)
42 Repeater tone (0=OFF; 1=ON)
43 Tone squelch (0=OFF; 1=ON)
44
Speech compressor (0=OFF; 1=ON)
45 Monitor (0=OFF; 1=ON)
46 VOX function (0=OFF; 1=ON)
47 Break-in (0=OFF; 1=semi break-
in; 2=full break-in)
48 Manual notch (0=OFF; 1=ON)
49 RTTY filter (0=OFF; 1=ON)
4F Twin peak filter (0=OFF; 1=ON)
50 Dial lock (0=OFF; 1=ON)
19 00 Read the transceiver ID
1A 00 Send/read memory contents (see
p. 114 for details)
01 Send/read band stacking register
contents (see p. 114 for details)
02 Send/read memory keyer con-
tents (see p. 114 for details)
03 Send/read the selected filter width
(0=50 Hz to 40/31=3600/2700 Hz)
04 Send/read the selected AGC time
constant (0=OFF, 1=0.1/0.3 sec. to
13=6.0/8.0 sec.)
0501 Send/read SSB TX Tone (Bass)
level (0 =min. to 10=max.)
0502 Send/read SSB TX Tone (Treble)
level (0=min. to 10=max.)
0503 Send/read MONITOR gain (0=min.
to 255=max.)
0504 Send/read CW side tone gain
(0=min. to 255=max.)
0505 Send/read CW side tone gain limit
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0506 Send/read beep gain (0=min. to
255=max.)
0507 Send/read beep gain limit (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0508 Send/read LCD contrast (0=0% to
255=100%)
0509 Send/read LCD backlight (0=0% to
255=100%)
0510 Send/read LCD horizontal position
(0=1 to 7=8)
0511 Send/read switch backlight (0=1 to
7=8)
0512 Send/read display type (0=A, 1=B,
2=C, 3=D, 4=E, 5=F, 6=G, 7=H)
0513 Send/read display font (0=Basic1,
1=Basic2, 2=Pop, 3=7seg,
4=Italic1, 5=italic2, 6=Classic)
0514 Send/read memory name (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0515 Send/read my call setting (10-char-
acter: see p. 114)
0516 Send/read current time (0000 to
2359)
Command Sub command Description Command Sub command Description
16
113
16
CONTROL COMMAND
•Command table (continued)
1A 0570 Send/read SSB transmit band-
width for WIDE setting
(Low: 100/300/500 Hz,
High: 2500/2700/2900 Hz)
0571 Send/read SSB transmit band-
width for MID setting
(Low: 100/300/500 Hz,
High: 2500/2700/2900 Hz)
0572 Send/read SSB transmit band-
width-NAR setting
(Low: 100/300/500 Hz,
High: 2500/2700/2900 Hz)
0573 Send/read clock2 function
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0574 Send/read offset time for clock2
(240001=–24:00, 240000=+24:00)
0575 Send/read screen saver setting
(0=OFF, 1=15 min, 2=30 min,
3=60 min)
0576 Send/read RTTY TX USOS
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
06 Send/read DATA mode (0=OFF,
1=ON)
07 Send/read SSB transmit band-
width (0=Wide, 1=Middle, 2=Nar-
row)
1B 00 Set repeater tone frequency
01 Set tone squelch tone frequency
1C 00 Set the transceiver to receive or
transmit condition (0=Rx; 1=Tx)
01 Send/read tuner function (0=OFF,
1=ON, 2=Manual tune)
1A 0544 Send/read TX spectrum scope set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0545 Send/read spectrum scope max.
hold set (0=OFF, 1=ON)
0546 Send/read voice auto monitor set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0547 Send/read cut number style
(0=Normal, 1=190ANO,
2=190ANT, 3=90NO,
4=90NT)
0548 Send/read count up trigger chan-
nel (1=M1, 2=M2, 3=M3, 4=M4)
0549 Send/read present number
(1–9999)
0550 Send/read CW keyer repeat time
(1=1 sec. to 60=60 sec.)
0551 Send/read CW keyer dot/dash
ratio (28=1:1:2.8 to 45=1:1:4.5)
0552 Send/read rise time (0=2 msec.,
1=4 msec., 2=6 msec., 3=8 msec.)
0553 Send/read paddle polarity
(0=Normal, 1=Reverse)
0554 Send/read keyer type (0=Straight,
1=Bug-key, 2=ELEC-Key)
0555 Send/read mic. up/down keyer set
(0=OFF, 1=ON)
0556 Send/read scan speed (0=low,
1=high)
0557 Send/read scan resume (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0558 Send/read VOX gain (0=0% to
255=100%)
0559 Send/read anti VOX gain (0=0% to
255=100%)
0560 Send/read VOX delay (0=0.0 sec.
to 20=2.0 sec.)
0561 Send/read RTTY filter bandwidth
(0=250 Hz, 1=300 Hz, 2=350 Hz,
3=500 Hz, 4=1 kHz)
0562 Send/read twin peak filter (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0563 Send/read timer functions (0=OFF,
1=ON)
0564 Send/read DSP filter type
(0=SSB: sharp; CW: sharp,
1=SSB: sharp; CW: soft,
2=SSB: soft CW: sharp,
3=SSB: soft CW: soft)
0565 Send/read quick RIT/TX clear
function (0=OFF, 1=ON)
0566 Send/read SSB/CW synchronous
tuning function (0=OFF, 1=ON)
0567 Send/read CW normal side set
(0=LSB, 1=USB)
0568 Send/read external keypad type
(0=OFF, 1=Keyer send, 2=Voice
play (Tx), 3=Auto)
0569 Send/read NB level (0=0% to
255=100%)
Command Sub command Description Command Sub command Description
114
16
CONTROL COMMAND
•To send/read memory contents
When sending or reading memory contents, additional code
as follows must be added to appoint the memory channel.
Additional code: 0000–0101 (0100=P1, 0101=P2)
•Band stacking register
To send or read the desired band stacking register’s con-
tents, combined code of the frequency band and register
codes as follows are used.
For example, when sending/reading the oldest contents in
the 21 MHz band, the code “0703” is used.
Frequency band code
• Channel code for memory keyer
To send or read the desired memory keyer contents, the
channel and character codes as follows are used.
•Channel code
• Characters code
• Characters code for my call
FM split frequency (HF/50 MHz) setting
The following data sequence is used when sending/reading
the FM split frequency setting.
1 kHz digit: 0–9
100 Hz digit: 0 (fixed)
100 kHz digit: 0–9
10 kHz digit: 0–9
10 MHz digit: 0 (fixed)
1 MHz digit: 0–4
Direction:
00=+ direction
01=– direction
q
0XXXXXX
we
0
r
Code Frequency band Frequency range (unit: MHz)
01 1.8 1.800000– 1.999999
02 3.5 3.400000– 4.099999
03 7 6.900000– 7.499999
04 10 9.900000–10.499999
05 14 13.900000–14.499999
06 18 17.900000–18.499999
07 21 20.900000–21.499999
08 24 24.400000–25.099999
09 28 28.000000–29.999999
10 50 50.000000–54.000000
11 GENE Other than above
Character ASCII code Description
0–9 30–39 Numerals
A–Z 41–5A Alphabetical characters
a–z 61–7A Alphabetical characters
space 20 Word space
/2FSymbol
?3FSymbol
,2CSymbol
.2ESymbol
^5Ee.g., to send
BT
, enter ^4254
2A Inserts contact number (can be
used for 1 channel only)
Code Channel number
01 M1
02 M2
03 M3
04 M4
Character ASCII code Description
0–9 30–39 Numerals
A–Z 41–5A Alphabetical characters
a–z 61–7A Alphabetical characters
space 20 Word space
–2DSymbol
.2ESymbol
/2FSymbol
Register code
Code Registered number
01 1 (latest)
02 2
03 3 (oldest)
16
17
115
SPECIFICATIONS
•General
Frequency coverage : (unit: MHz)
Receiver 0.030–60.000*
1
*
2
Transmitter 1.800–1.999*
2
, 3.500–3.999*
2
,
5.33050*
3
, 5.34650*
3
, 5.36650*
3
,
5.37150*
3
, 5.40350*
3
,
7.000–7.300*
2
, 10.100–10.150*
2
,
14.000–14.350*
2
, 18.068–18.168*
2
,
21.000–21.450*
2
, 24.890–24.990*
2
,
28.000–29.700*
2
, 50.000–54.000*
2
*
1
Some frequency bands are not guaranteed.
*
2
Depending on version. *
3
USA version only.
Mode : USB, LSB, CW, RTTY, AM, FM
No. of memory channels : 101
(99 regular, 2 scan edges)
Antenna connector : SO-239× 2 and phono jacks
(RCA; 50 )
•Temperature range : –10˚C to +50˚C
; +14˚F to +122˚F
Frequency stability : Less than ±0.5 ppm 1 min. after
power ON.
(–10 to +50˚C; +14 to
+122˚F)
Frequency resolution : 1 Hz
Power supply : 13.8 V DC ±15%
(negative ground)
Power consumption :
Transmit Max. power 23 A
Receive Standby 3.0 A (typ.)
Max. audio 3.3 A (typ.)
Dimensions : 340(W)×111(H)× 285(D) mm
(projections not included) 13
3
8(W)×4
3
8(H)×11
7
32(D) in
•Weight (approx.) : 9.6 kg; 21 lb 3 oz
ACC 1 connector : 8-pin DIN connector
ACC 2 connector : 7-pin DIN connector
CI-V connector : 2-conductor 3.5 (d) mm (
1
8
)
Display : 5-inch
(diagonal) TFT color LCD
•Transmitter
•Output power (continuously adjustable):
SSB/CW/RTTY/FM Less than 5 to 100 W
AM Less than 5 to 40 W
Modulation system :
SSB PSN modulation
AM Low power modulation
FM Phase modulation
Spurious emission : 50 dB
(HF bands)
60 dB (50 MHz band)
Carrier suppression : 40 dB
Unwanted sideband : 55 dB
suppression
TX variable range : ±9.999 kHz
Microphone connector : 8-pin connector
(600 )
ELEC-KEY connector :
3-conductor 6.35(d) mm
(
1
4)
KEY connector :
3-conductor 6.35(d) mm
(
1
4
)
SEND connector : Phono jack
(RCA)
ALC connector : Phono jack (RCA)
Receiver
Receive system : Triple conversion
superheterodyne system
Intermediate frequencies :
1st 64.455 MHz
2nd 455 kHz
3rd 36 kHz
Sensitivity (typical) :
SSB, CW, RTTY 0.16 µV
(1.80–29.99 MHz)*
1
(10 dB S/N) BW=2.4 kHz 0.13 µV
(50.0–54.0 MHz)*
2
AM (10 dB S/N) 13 µV
(0.5–1.799 MHz)
BW=6 kHz
2 µV (1.80–29.99 MHz)*
1
1 µV
(50.0–54.0 MHz)*
2
FM (12 dB SINAD) 0.5 µV
(28.0–29.99 MHz)*
1
BW=15 kHz 0.32 µV (50.0–54.0 MHz)*
2
*
1
Pre-amp 1 is ON, *
2
Pre-amp 2 is ON
Squelch sensitivity (Pre-amp: OFF):
SSB, CW, RTTY Less than 5.6 µV
FM Less than 1 µV
Selectivity :
SSB, RTTY More than 2.4 kHz/–6 dB
(BW: 2.4 kHz) Less than 3.6 kHz/–60 dB
CW (BW: 500 Hz) More than 500 Hz/–6 dB
Less than 700 Hz/–60 dB
AM (BW: 6 kHz) More than 6.0 kHz/–6 dB
Less than 15.0 kHz/–60 dB
FM (BW: 15 kHz) More than 12.0 kHz/–6 dB
Less than 20.0 kHz/–60 dB
Spurious and image : More than 70 dB
rejection ratio
(except IF through on 50 MHz band)
AF output power : More than 2.0 W at 10%
(at 13.8 V DC) distortion with an 8 load
RIT variable range : ±9.999 kHz
PHONES connector : 3-conductor 6.35 (d) mm (
1
4
)
External SP connector : 2-conductor 3.5 (d) mm
(
1
8)/8
Antenna tuner
Matching impedance range:
HF bands 16.7 to 150 unbalanced
(Less than VSWR 3:1)
50 MHz band 20 to 125 unbalanced
(Less than VSWR 2.5:1)
Minimum operating input : 8 W
power
•Tuning accuracy : VSWR 1.5:1 or less
Insertion loss
(after tuning): Less than 1.0 dB
All stated specifications are typical and subject to change without no-
tice or obligation.
18
116
OPTIONS
IC-PW1/EURO HF/50 MHz ALL BAND 1 kW LINEAR AMPLIFIER
Full-duty 1 kW linear amplifier including an automatic antenna tuner. Has
automatic tuning and band selection capability. Full break-in (QSK) oper-
ation is possible. The amplifier/power supply unit and the remote control
unit are separated.
AH-4 HF/50 MHz AUTOMATIC
ANTENNA TUNER
Specially designed to tune a long
wire antenna for portable or mobile
HF operation. The PTT tuner start
function provides simple operation.
Input power rating: 120 W
AH-2b ANTENNA ELEMENT
A 2.5 m long an-
tenna element for
mobile operation
with the AH-4.
Frequency
coverage:
7–54 MHz bands
with the AH-4
SM-20 DESKTOP MICROPHONE
Unidirectional, electret microphone
for base station operation. Includes
[UP]/[DOWN] switches and a low
cut function.
SP-23 EXTERNAL SPEAKER
4 audio filters; headphone jack; can
connect to 2 transceivers.
Input impedance: 8
Max. input power: 4 W
CT-17 CI-V LEVEL CONVERTER
For remote transceiver control
using a personal computer. You
can change frequencies, operating
mode, memory channels, etc.
HM-36 HAND MICROPHONE
Hand microphone equipped with
[UP]/[DN] switches.
UT-102 VOICE SYNTHESIZER UNIT
Announces the receive frequency, mode
and S-meter level in a clear, electroni-
cally-generated voice, in English (or
Japanese).
PS-125 DC POWER SUPPLY
Light weight switching regulator
system power supply.
Output voltage: 13.8 V DC
•Max. current drain: 25 A
•About DC power supply
The use of IC-756PROIII (#33, #34, #35, #38, #40) in com-
bination with the DC power supply complies with European
Harmonised Standard regulations under the conditions
listed below.
Conditions
•In combination with PS-125
17
18
19
117
ABOUT CE
INSTALLATION NOTES
For amateur base station installations it is recom-
mended that the forwards clearance in front of the an-
tenna array is calculated relative to the EIRP (Effective
Isotropic Radiated Power). The clearance height below
the antenna array can be determined in most cases
from the RF power at the antenna input terminals.
As different exposure limits have been recommended
for different frequencies, a relative table shows a
guideline for installation considerations.
Below 30 MHz, the recommended limits are specified
in terms of V/m or A/m fields as they are likely to fall
within the near-field region. Similarly, the antennae
may be physically short in terms of electrical length
and that the installation will require some antenna
matching device which can create local, high intensity
magnetic fields. Analysis of such MF installations is
best considered in association with published guidance
notes such as the FCC OET Bulletin 65 Edition 97-01
and its annexes relative to amateur transmitter instal-
lations. The EC recommended limits are almost identi-
cal to the FCC specified ‘uncontrolled’ limits and tables
exist that show pre-calculated safe distances for differ-
ent antenna types for different frequency bands. Fur-
ther information can be found at http://www.arrl.org/.
•Typical amateur radio installation
Exposure distance assumes that the predominant ra-
diation pattern is forwards and that radiation vertically
downwards is at unity gain (sidelobe suppression is
equal to main lobe gain). This is true of almost every
gain antenna today. Exposed persons are assumed to
be beneath the antenna array and have a typical
height to 1.8 m.
The figures assume the worst case emission of con-
stant carrier.
For the bands 10 MHz and higher the following power
density limits have been recommended:
10–50 MHz 2 W/sq m
EIRP clearance heights by frequency band
1 Watts 2.1 m
10 Watts 2.8 m
25 Watts 3.4 m
100 Watts 5 m
1000 Watts 12 m
Forward clearance, EIRP by frequency band
100 Watts 2 m
1000 Watts 6.5 m
10,000 Watts 20 m
100,000 Watts 65 m
In all cases any possible risk depends on the transmit-
ter being activated for long periods. (actual recom-
mendation limits are specified as an average during 6
minutes) Normally the transmitter is not active for long
periods of time. Some radio licenses will require that a
timer circuit automatically cuts the transmitter after 1–2
minutes etc.
Similarly some types of transmitter, SSB, CW, AM etc.
have a lower ‘average’ output power and the assessed
risk is even lower.
Versions of the IC-756PROIII which display
the “CE” symbol on the serial number seal,
comply with the essential requirements of
the European Radio and Telecommunication
Terminal Directive 1999/5/EC.
This warning symbol indicates that this
equipment operates in non-harmonised fre-
quency bands and/or may be subject to li-
censing conditions in the country of use. Be
sure to check that you have the correct ver-
sion of this radio or the correct programming
of this radio, to comply with national licens-
ing requirement.
118
19
ABOUT CE
DECLARATION
OF CONFORMITY
We Icom Inc. Japan
1-1-32, Kamiminami, Hirano-ku
Osaka 547-0003, Japan
Kind of equipment: HF/
50 MHz ALL MODE TRANSCEIVER
This compliance is based on conformity according to Annex III of the
directive 1999/5/EC using the following harmonised standards:
i) Article 3.1a EN 60950 + A11
ii) Article 3.1b EN 301489-1 and EN 301489-15
iii) Article 3.2 EN 301 783-2
Type-designation:
Declare on our sole responsibility that this equipment complies with the
essential requirements of the Radio and Telecommunications Terminal
Equipment Directive, 1999/5/EC, and that any applicable Essential Test
Suite measurements have been performed.
Version (where applicable):
Signature
H. Ikegami
General Manager
Authorized representative name
Icom (Europe) GmbH
Himmelgeister straße 100
D-40225 Düsseldorf
Place and date of issue
Düsseldorf 1st Sep. 2004
19
1-1-32 Kamiminami, Hirano-ku, Osaka 547-0003, Japan
IC-756PROIII
#33 (Europe)
IC-756PROIII
#34 (France)
IC-756PROIII
#35 (UK)
IC-756PROIII
#38 (Italy)
IC-756PROIII
#40 (Spain)
A-6378H-1EX-q
Printed in Japan
© 2004–2005 Icom Inc.
<Intended Country of Use>
GER FRA ESP SWE
AUT NED PORDEN
GBR BEL ITA FIN
IRL LUX GRE SUI
NOR
<Intended Country of Use>
GER FRA ESP SWE
AUT NED PORDEN
GBR BEL ITA FIN
IRL LUX GRESUI
NOR
<Intended Country of Use>
GER FRA ESP SWE
AUT NED PORDEN
GBR BEL ITA FIN
IRL LUX GRESUI
NOR
<Intended Country of Use>
GER FRA ESP SWE
AUT NED PORDEN
GBR BEL ITA FIN
IRL LUX GRESUI
NOR
<Intended Country of Use>
GER FRA ESP SWE
AUT NED PORDEN
GBR BEL ITA FIN
IRL LUX GRESUI
NOR
121


Need help? Post your question in this forum.

Forumrules


Report abuse

Libble takes abuse of its services very seriously. We're committed to dealing with such abuse according to the laws in your country of residence. When you submit a report, we'll investigate it and take the appropriate action. We'll get back to you only if we require additional details or have more information to share.

Product:

For example, Anti-Semitic content, racist content, or material that could result in a violent physical act.

For example, a credit card number, a personal identification number, or an unlisted home address. Note that email addresses and full names are not considered private information.

Forumrules

To achieve meaningful questions, we apply the following rules:

Register

Register getting emails for Icom IC-756 at:


You will receive an email to register for one or both of the options.


Get your user manual by e-mail

Enter your email address to receive the manual of Icom IC-756 in the language / languages: English as an attachment in your email.

The manual is 3,53 mb in size.

 

You will receive the manual in your email within minutes. If you have not received an email, then probably have entered the wrong email address or your mailbox is too full. In addition, it may be that your ISP may have a maximum size for emails to receive.

Others manual(s) of Icom IC-756

Icom IC-756 User Manual - English - 72 pages


The manual is sent by email. Check your email

If you have not received an email with the manual within fifteen minutes, it may be that you have a entered a wrong email address or that your ISP has set a maximum size to receive email that is smaller than the size of the manual.

The email address you have provided is not correct.

Please check the email address and correct it.

Your question is posted on this page

Would you like to receive an email when new answers and questions are posted? Please enter your email address.



Info